PIC12F683 Data Sheet

PIC12F683
Data Sheet
8-Pin Flash-Based, 8-Bit
CMOS Microcontrollers with
nanoWatt Technology
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D
Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices:
•
Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet.
•
Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the
intended manner and under normal conditions.
•
There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our
knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data
Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property.
•
Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code.
•
Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not
mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our
products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts
allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act.
Information contained in this publication regarding device
applications and the like is provided only for your convenience
and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to
ensure that your application meets with your specifications.
MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR
WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR
OTHERWISE, RELATED TO THE INFORMATION,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION,
QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY OR
FITNESS FOR PURPOSE. Microchip disclaims all liability
arising from this information and its use. Use of Microchip
devices in life support and/or safety applications is entirely at
the buyer’s risk, and the buyer agrees to defend, indemnify and
hold harmless Microchip from any and all damages, claims,
suits, or expenses resulting from such use. No licenses are
conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any Microchip
intellectual property rights.
Trademarks
The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, Accuron,
dsPIC, KEELOQ, KEELOQ logo, microID, MPLAB, PIC,
PICmicro, PICSTART, PRO MATE, PowerSmart, rfPIC, and
SmartShunt are registered trademarks of Microchip
Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries.
AmpLab, FilterLab, Linear Active Thermistor, Migratable
Memory, MXDEV, MXLAB, PS logo, SEEVAL, SmartSensor
and The Embedded Control Solutions Company are
registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A.
Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Application Maestro, CodeGuard,
dsPICDEM, dsPICDEM.net, dsPICworks, ECAN,
ECONOMONITOR, FanSense, FlexROM, fuzzyLAB,
In-Circuit Serial Programming, ICSP, ICEPIC, Mindi, MiWi,
MPASM, MPLAB Certified logo, MPLIB, MPLINK, PICkit,
PICDEM, PICDEM.net, PICLAB, PICtail, PowerCal,
PowerInfo, PowerMate, PowerTool, REAL ICE, rfLAB,
rfPICDEM, Select Mode, Smart Serial, SmartTel, Total
Endurance, UNI/O, WiperLock and ZENA are trademarks of
Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other
countries.
SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A.
All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their
respective companies.
© 2007, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in the
U.S.A., All Rights Reserved.
Printed on recycled paper.
Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2002 certification for its worldwide
headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in Chandler and
Tempe, Arizona, Gresham, Oregon and Mountain View, California. The
Company’s quality system processes and procedures are for its PIC®
MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs, KEELOQ® code hopping devices, Serial
EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and analog
products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design and
manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified.
DS41211D-page ii
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
8-Pin Flash-Based, 8-Bit CMOS Microcontrollers with
nanoWatt Technology
High-Performance RISC CPU:
Low-Power Features:
• Only 35 instructions to learn:
- All single-cycle instructions except branches
• Operating speed:
- DC – 20 MHz oscillator/clock input
- DC – 200 ns instruction cycle
• Interrupt capability
• 8-level deep hardware stack
• Direct, Indirect and Relative Addressing modes
• Standby Current:
- 50 nA @ 2.0V, typical
• Operating Current:
- 11 μA @ 32 kHz, 2.0V, typical
- 220 μA @ 4 MHz, 2.0V, typical
• Watchdog Timer Current:
- 1 μA @ 2.0V, typical
Peripheral Features:
Special Microcontroller Features:
• 6 I/O pins with individual direction control:
- High current source/sink for direct LED drive
- Interrupt-on-pin change
- Individually programmable weak pull-ups
- Ultra Low-Power Wake-up on GP0
• Analog Comparator module with:
- One analog comparator
- Programmable on-chip voltage reference
(CVREF) module (% of VDD)
- Comparator inputs and output externally
accessible
• A/D Converter:
- 10-bit resolution and 4 channels
• Timer0: 8-bit timer/counter with 8-bit
programmable prescaler
• Enhanced Timer1:
- 16-bit timer/counter with prescaler
- External Timer1 Gate (count enable)
- Option to use OSC1 and OSC2 in LP mode as
Timer1 oscillator if INTOSC mode selected
• Timer2: 8-bit timer/counter with 8-bit period
register, prescaler and postscaler
• Capture, Compare, PWM module:
- 16-bit Capture, max resolution 12.5 ns
- Compare, max resolution 200 ns
- 10-bit PWM, max frequency 20 kHz
• In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) via
two pins
• Precision Internal Oscillator:
- Factory calibrated to ±1%, typical
- Software selectable frequency range of
8 MHz to 125 kHz
- Software tunable
- Two-Speed Start-up mode
- Crystal fail detect for critical applications
- Clock mode switching during operation for
power savings
• Power-Saving Sleep mode
• Wide operating voltage range (2.0V-5.5V)
• Industrial and Extended temperature range
• Power-on Reset (POR)
• Power-up Timer (PWRT) and Oscillator Start-up
Timer (OST)
• Brown-out Reset (BOR) with software control
option
• Enhanced Low-Current Watchdog Timer (WDT)
with on-chip oscillator (software selectable nominal 268 seconds with full prescaler) with software
enable
• Multiplexed Master Clear with pull-up/input pin
• Programmable code protection
• High Endurance Flash/EEPROM cell:
- 100,000 write Flash endurance
- 1,000,000 write EEPROM endurance
- Flash/Data EEPROM Retention: > 40 years
Program Memory
Data Memory
Device
PIC12F683
I/O
Flash (words)
SRAM (bytes)
EEPROM (bytes)
2048
128
256
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
6
10-bit A/D (ch) Comparators
4
1
Timers
8/16-bit
2/1
DS41211D-page 1
PIC12F683
VDD
1
GP5/T1CKI/OSC1/CLKIN
2
GP4/AN3/T1G/OSC2/CLKOUT
3
GP3/MCLR/VPP
4
PIC12F683
8-Pin Diagram (PDIP, SOIC)
8
VSS
7
GP0/AN0/CIN+/ICSPDAT/ULPWU
6
GP1/AN1/CIN-/VREF/ICSPCLK
5
GP2/AN2/T0CKI/INT/COUT/CCP1
8-Pin Diagram (DFN)
VDD
1
GP5/TICKI/OSC1/CLKIN
2
PIC12F683
8
VSS
7
GP0/AN0/CIN+/ICSPDAT/ULPWU
GP4/AN3/TIG/OSC2/CLKOUT
3
6
GP1/AN1/CIN-/VREF/ICSPCLK
GP3/MCLR/VPP
4
5
GP2/AN2/T0CKI/INT/COUT/CCP1
VDD
1
8
VSS
GP5/TICKI/OSC1/CLKIN
2
7
GP0/AN0/CIN+/ICSPDAT/ULPWU
8-Pin Diagram (DFN-S)
PIC12F683
GP4/AN3/TIG/OSC2/CLKOUT
3
6
GP1/AN1/CIN-/VREF/ICSPCLK
GP3/MCLR/VPP
4
5
GP2/AN2/T0CKI/INT/COUT/CCP1
TABLE 1:
I/O
8-PIN SUMMARY
Pin
Analog
Comparators
Timer
CCP
Interrupts
Pull-ups
Basic
GP0
7
AN0
CIN+
—
—
IOC
Y
ICSPDAT/ULPWU
GP1
6
AN1/VREF
CIN-
—
—
IOC
Y
ICSPCLK
GP2
5
AN2
COUT
T0CKI
CCP1
INT/IOC
Y
—
MCLR/VPP
GP3(1)
4
—
—
—
—
IOC
Y(2)
GP4
3
AN3
—
T1G
—
IOC
Y
OSC2/CLKOUT
GP5
2
—
—
T1CKI
—
IOC
Y
OSC1/CLKIN
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
VDD
—
8
—
—
—
—
—
—
VSS
Note 1:
2:
Input only.
Only when pin is configured for external MCLR.
DS41211D-page 2
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
Table of Contents
1.0 Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 5
2.0 Memory Organization ................................................................................................................................................................... 7
3.0 Oscillator Module (With Fail-Safe Clock Monitor)....................................................................................................................... 19
4.0 GPIO Port................................................................................................................................................................................... 31
5.0 Timer0 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 41
6.0 Timer1 Module with Gate Control............................................................................................................................................... 44
7.0 Timer2 Module ........................................................................................................................................................................... 49
8.0 Comparator Module.................................................................................................................................................................... 51
9.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module ................................................................................................................................ 61
10.0 Data EEPROM Memory ............................................................................................................................................................. 71
11.0 Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) Module ..................................................................................................................................... 75
12.0 Special Features of the CPU...................................................................................................................................................... 83
13.0 Instruction Set Summary .......................................................................................................................................................... 101
14.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 111
15.0 Electrical Specifications............................................................................................................................................................ 115
16.0 DC and AC Characteristics Graphs and Tables....................................................................................................................... 137
17.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 159
Appendix A: Data Sheet Revision History.......................................................................................................................................... 165
Appendix B: Migrating From Other PIC® Devices ............................................................................................................................. 165
The Microchip Web Site ..................................................................................................................................................................... 171
Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 171
Customer Support .............................................................................................................................................................................. 171
Reader Response .............................................................................................................................................................................. 172
Product Identification System ............................................................................................................................................................ 173
TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS
It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip
products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and
enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced.
If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via
E-mail at [email protected] or fax the Reader Response Form in the back of this data sheet to (480) 792-4150. We
welcome your feedback.
Most Current Data Sheet
To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Web site at:
http://www.microchip.com
You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page.
The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000A is version A of document DS30000).
Errata
An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current
devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision
of silicon and revision of document to which it applies.
To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following:
• Microchip’s Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com
• Your local Microchip sales office (see last page)
When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are
using.
Customer Notification System
Register on our web site at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 3
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 4
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
1.0
DEVICE OVERVIEW
The PIC12F683 is covered by this data sheet. It is
available in 8-pin PDIP, SOIC and DFN-S packages.
Figure 1-1 shows a block diagram of the PIC12F683
device. Table 1-1 shows the pinout description.
FIGURE 1-1:
PIC12F683 BLOCK DIAGRAM
INT
Configuration
13
Flash
2k x 14
Program
Memory
Program
Bus
8
Data Bus
Program Counter
GP0
GP1
GP2
RAM
128 bytes
8-Level Stack
(13-bit)
GP3
GP4
File
Registers
14
RAM Addr
GP5
9
Addr MUX
Instruction Reg
7
Direct Addr
Indirect
Addr
8
FSR Reg
STATUS Reg
8
3
MUX
Power-up
Timer
Instruction
Decode &
Control
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
Timing
Generation
OSC1/CLKIN
ALU
Power-on
Reset
8
Watchdog
Timer
W Reg
Brown-out
Reset
OSC2/CLKOUT
Internal
Oscillator
Block
CCP1
T1G
MCLR
VDD
VSS
T1CKI
Timer0
Timer1
Timer2
CCP
T0CKI
Analog-to-Digital Converter
EEDATA
1 Analog Comparator
8
256 bytes
Data
EEPROM
EEADDR
VREF
AN0 AN1 AN2 AN3
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
CVREF
CIN-
CIN+
COUT
DS41211D-page 5
PIC12F683
TABLE 1-1:
PIC12F683 PINOUT DESCRIPTION
Name
VDD
GP5/T1CKI/OSC1/CLKIN
GP4/AN3/T1G/OSC2/CLKOUT
GP3/MCLR/VPP
GP2/AN2/T0CKI/INT/COUT/CCP1
GP1/AN1/CIN-/VREF/ICSPCLK
GP0/AN0/CIN+/ICSPDAT/ULPWU
VSS
Legend:
Function
Input
Type
Output
Type
VDD
Power
—
Positive supply
GP5
TTL
CMOS
T1CKI
ST
—
Timer1 clock
GPIO I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change
OSC1
XTAL
—
Crystal/Resonator
CLKIN
ST
—
External clock input/RC oscillator connection
GP4
TTL
CMOS
AN3
AN
—
GPIO I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change
A/D Channel 3 input
T1G
ST
—
OSC2
—
XTAL
Crystal/Resonator
CLKOUT
—
CMOS
FOSC/4 output
Timer1 gate
GP3
TTL
—
GPIO input with interrupt-on-change
MCLR
ST
—
Master Clear with internal pull-up
VPP
HV
—
Programming voltage
GP2
ST
CMOS
AN2
AN
—
A/D Channel 2 input
T0CKI
ST
—
Timer0 clock input
INT
ST
—
External Interrupt
COUT
—
CMOS
Comparator 1 output
CCP1
ST
CMOS
Capture input/Compare output/PWM output
GP1
TTL
CMOS
AN1
AN
—
A/D Channel 1 input
Comparator 1 input
GPIO I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change
GPIO I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change
CIN-
AN
—
VREF
AN
—
External Voltage Reference for A/D
ICSPCLK
ST
—
Serial Programming Clock
GP0
TTL
CMOS
GPIO I/O with prog. pull-up and interrupt-on-change
AN0
AN
—
A/D Channel 0 input
CIN+
AN
—
Comparator 1 input
ICSPDAT
ST
CMOS
ULPWU
AN
—
Ultra Low-Power Wake-up input
VSS
Power
—
Ground reference
AN = Analog input or output
TTL = TTL compatible input
HV = High Voltage
DS41211D-page 6
Description
Serial Programming Data I/O
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST
= Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
XTAL = Crystal
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
2.0
MEMORY ORGANIZATION
2.1
Program Memory Organization
The PIC12F683 has a 13-bit program counter capable
of addressing an 8k x 14 program memory space. Only
the first 2k x 14 (0000h-07FFh) for the PIC12F683 is
physically implemented. Accessing a location above
these boundaries will cause a wraparound within the
first 2K x 14 space. The Reset vector is at 0000h and
the interrupt vector is at 0004h (see Figure 2-1).
FIGURE 2-1:
PROGRAM MEMORY MAP
AND STACK FOR THE
PIC12F683
PC<12:0>
CALL, RETURN
RETFIE, RETLW
2.2
Data Memory Organization
The data memory (see Figure 2-2) is partitioned into two
banks, which contain the General Purpose Registers
(GPR) and the Special Function Registers (SFR). The
Special Function Registers are located in the first 32
locations of each bank. Register locations 20h-7Fh in
Bank 0 and A0h-BFh in Bank 1 are General Purpose
Registers, implemented as static RAM. Register
locations F0h-FFh in Bank 1 point to addresses 70h-7Fh
in Bank 0. All other RAM is unimplemented and returns
‘0’ when read. RP0 of the STATUS register is the bank
select bit.
RP0
0
→
Bank 0 is selected
1
→
Bank 1 is selected
13
Note:
Stack Level 1
The IRP and RP1 bits of the STATUS
register are reserved and should always
be maintained as ‘0’s.
Stack Level 2
Stack Level 8
Reset Vector
0000h
Interrupt Vector
0004h
0005h
On-chip Program
Memory
07FFh
0800h
Wraps to 0000h-07FFh
1FFFh
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 7
PIC12F683
2.2.1
GENERAL PURPOSE REGISTER
FILE
The register file is organized as 128 x 8 in the
PIC12F683. Each register is accessed, either directly
or indirectly, through the File Select Register FSR (see
Section 2.4 “Indirect Addressing, INDF and FSR
Registers”).
2.2.2
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS
The Special Function Registers are registers used by
the CPU and peripheral functions for controlling the
desired operation of the device (see Table 2-1). These
registers are static RAM.
The special registers can be classified into two sets:
core and peripheral. The Special Function Registers
associated with the “core” are described in this section.
Those related to the operation of the peripheral
features are described in the section of that peripheral
feature.
FIGURE 2-2:
DATA MEMORY MAP OF
THE PIC12F683
File
Address
File
Address
Indirect addr.(1)
00h
Indirect addr.(1)
80h
TMR0
01h
OPTION_REG
81h
PCL
02h
PCL
82h
STATUS
03h
STATUS
83h
FSR
04h
FSR
84h
GPIO
05h
TRISIO
85h
06h
86h
07h
87h
08h
88h
09h
89h
PCLATH
0Ah
PCLATH
8Ah
INTCON
0Bh
INTCON
8Bh
PIR1
0Ch
PIE1
8Ch
0Dh
8Dh
TMR1L
0Eh
PCON
8Eh
TMR1H
0Fh
OSCCON
8Fh
T1CON
10h
OSCTUNE
90h
TMR2
11h
T2CON
12h
CCPR1L
13h
CCPR1H
14h
CCP1CON
15h
WPU
95h
16h
IOC
96h
91h
PR2
92h
93h
94h
17h
97h
WDTCON
18h
CMCON0
19h
VRCON
99h
CMCON1
1Ah
EEDAT
9Ah
1Bh
EEADR
9Bh
1Ch
EECON1
9Ch
1Dh
EECON2(1)
9Dh
ADRESH
1Eh
ADRESL
9Eh
ADCON0
1Fh
ANSEL
General
Purpose
Registers
32 Bytes
9Fh
A0h
20h
General
Purpose
Registers
98h
BFh
C0h
96 Bytes
Accesses 70h-7Fh
7Fh
BANK 0
EFh
F0h
FFh
BANK 1
Unimplemented data memory locations, read as ‘0’.
Note 1: Not a physical register.
DS41211D-page 8
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
TABLE 2-1:
Addr
Name
PIC12F683 SPECIAL REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Page
Bank 0
00h
INDF
01h
TMR0
Timer0 Module Register
xxxx xxxx 41, 90
02h
PCL
Program Counter’s (PC) Least Significant Byte
0000 0000 17, 90
03h
STATUS
04h
FSR
05h
GPIO
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) xxxx xxxx 17, 90
(1)
IRP
RP1
(1)
RP0
TO
PD
Z
DC
C
GP3
GP2
GP1
GP0
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer
—
—
GP5
GP4
0001 1xxx 11, 90
xxxx xxxx 17, 90
--xx xxxx 31, 90
06h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
07h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
08h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
09h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
PIR1
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
0Ah
PCLATH
0Bh
0Ch
0Dh
—
—
Write Buffer for upper 5 bits of Program Counter
---0 0000 17, 90
GPIF
Unimplemented
—
0Eh
TMR1L
Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1
0Fh
TMR1H
Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1
10h
T1CON
11h
TMR2
T1GINV
TMR1GE T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC
—
xxxx xxxx 44, 90
xxxx xxxx 44, 90
TMR1CS
TMR1ON 0000 0000 47, 90
Timer2 Module Register
0000 0000 49, 90
12h
T2CON
13h
CCPR1L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 Low Byte
14h
CCPR1H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 High Byte
15h
CCP1CON
16h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
17h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
18h
WDTCON
—
—
—
WDTPS3
WDTPS2
WDTPS1
WDTPS0
19h
CMCON0
—
COUT
—
CINV
CIS
CM2
CM1
1Ah
CMCON1
—
—
—
—
—
—
T1GSS
1Bh
—
Unimplemented
—
—
1Ch
—
Unimplemented
—
—
1Dh
—
Unimplemented
—
—
1Eh
ADRESH
1Fh
ADCON0
Legend:
Note 1:
—
0000 0000 13, 90
TMR1IF 000- 0000 15, 90
—
TOUTPS3 TOUTPS2 TOUTPS1 TOUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0 -000 0000 50, 90
—
DC1B1
DC1B0
xxxx xxxx 76, 90
xxxx xxxx 76, 90
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1
CCP1M0 --00 0000 75, 90
SWDTEN ---0 1000 97, 90
CM0
CMSYNC ---- --10 57, 90
Most Significant 8 bits of the left shifted A/D result or 2 bits of right shifted result
ADFM
VCFG
—
—
CHS1
CHS0
GO/DONE
-0-0 0000 56, 90
xxxx xxxx 61,90
ADON
00-- 0000 65,90
– = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition,
shaded = unimplemented
IRP and RP1 bits are reserved, always maintain these bits clear.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 9
PIC12F683
TABLE 2-2:
Addr
PIC12F683 SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 1
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Page
Bank 1
80h
INDF
81h
OPTION_REG
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) xxxx xxxx 17, 90
82h
PCL
GPPU
INTEDG
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
Program Counter’s (PC) Least Significant Byte
IRP(1)
RP1(1)
RP0
TO
1111 1111 12, 90
0000 0000 17, 90
PD
Z
DC
C
0001 1xxx 11, 90
83h
STATUS
84h
FSR
85h
TRISIO
86h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
87h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
88h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
89h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer
—
—
TRISIO5
TRISIO4
xxxx xxxx 17, 90
TRISIO3
TRISIO2
TRISIO1
8Ah
PCLATH
—
—
—
8Bh
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
8Ch PIE1
8Dh
—
TRISIO0 --11 1111 32, 90
Write Buffer for upper 5 bits of Program Counter
---0 0000 17, 90
GPIF
0000 0000 13, 90
TMR1IE 000- 0000 14, 90
Unimplemented
—
8Eh
PCON
—
—
—
—
POR
BOR
8Fh
OSCCON
—
IRCF2
IRCF1
IRCF0
OSTS(2)
HTS
LTS
SCS
-110 x000 20, 90
90h
OSCTUNE
—
—
—
TUN4
TUN3
TUN2
TUN1
TUN0
---0 0000 24, 90
91h
92h
—
PR2
ULPWUE SBOREN
—
Unimplemented
--01 --qq 16, 90
—
Timer2 Module Period Register
—
1111 1111 49, 90
93h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
94h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
(3)
95h
WPU
—
—
WPU5
WPU4
—
WPU2
WPU1
WPU0
--11 -111 34, 90
96h
IOC
—
—
IOC5
IOC4
IOC3
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
--00 0000 34, 90
97h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
98h
—
Unimplemented
—
—
99h
VRCON
VREN
—
VRR
—
VR3
VR2
VR1
9Ah
EEDAT
EEDAT7
EEDAT6
EEDAT5
EEDAT4
EEDAT3
EEDAT2
EEDAT1
EEDAT0 0000 0000 71, 90
9Bh
EEADR
EEADR7
EEADR6
EEADR5
EEADR4
EEADR3
EEADR2
EEADR1
EEADR0 0000 0000 71, 90
—
—
—
—
WRERR
WREN
WR
9Ch EECON1
VR0
RD
9Dh EECON2
EEPROM Control Register 2 (not a physical register)
9Eh
ADRESL
Least Significant 2 bits of the left shifted result or 8 bits of the right shifted result
9Fh
ANSEL
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
—
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
ANS3
0-0- 0000 58, 90
---- x000 72, 91
---- ---- 72, 91
ANS2
ANS1
xxxx xxxx 66, 91
ANS0
-000 1111 33, 91
– = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition,
shaded = unimplemented
IRP and RP1 bits are reserved, always maintain these bits clear.
OSTS bit of the OSCCON register reset to ‘0’ with Dual Speed Start-up and LP, HS or XT selected as the oscillator.
GP3 pull-up is enabled when MCLRE is ‘1’ in the Configuration Word register.
DS41211D-page 10
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
2.2.2.1
STATUS Register
The STATUS register, shown in Register 2-1, contains:
• Arithmetic status of the ALU
• Reset status
• Bank select bits for data memory (SRAM)
The STATUS register can be the destination for any
instruction, like any other register. If the STATUS
register is the destination for an instruction that affects
the Z, DC or C bits, then the write to these three bits is
disabled. These bits are set or cleared according to the
device logic. Furthermore, the TO and PD bits are not
writable. Therefore, the result of an instruction with the
STATUS register as destination may be different than
intended.
REGISTER 2-1:
For example, CLRF STATUS, will clear the upper three
bits and set the Z bit. This leaves the STATUS register
as 000u u1uu (where u = unchanged).
It is recommended, therefore, that only BCF, BSF,
SWAPF and MOVWF instructions are used to alter the
STATUS register, because these instructions do not
affect any Status bits. For other instructions not affecting any Status bits, see the “Instruction Set Summary”.
Note 1: Bits IRP and RP1 of the STATUS register
are not used by the PIC12F683 and
should be maintained as clear. Use of
these bits is not recommended, since this
may affect upward compatibility with
future products.
2: The C and DC bits operate as a Borrow
and Digit Borrow out bit, respectively, in
subtraction.
STATUS: STATUS REGISTER
Reserved
Reserved
R/W-0
R-1
R-1
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
IRP
RP1
RP0
TO
PD
Z
DC
C
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
IRP: This bit is reserved and should be maintained as ‘0’
bit 6
RP1: This bit is reserved and should be maintained as ‘0’
bit 5
RP0: Register Bank Select bit (used for direct addressing)
1 = Bank 1 (80h – FFh)
0 = Bank 0 (00h – 7Fh)
bit 4
TO: Time-out bit
1 = After power-up, CLRWDT instruction or SLEEP instruction
0 = A WDT time-out occurred
bit 3
PD: Power-down bit
1 = After power-up or by the CLRWDT instruction
0 = By execution of the SLEEP instruction
bit 2
Z: Zero bit
1 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is zero
0 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is not zero
bit 1
DC: Digit Carry/Borrow bit (ADDWF, ADDLW,SUBLW,SUBWF instructions), For Borrow, the polarity is
reversed.
1 = A carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result occurred
0 = No carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result
bit 0
C: Carry/Borrow bit(1) (ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLW, SUBWF instructions)
1 = A carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
0 = No carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
Note 1:
For Borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the two’s complement of the
second operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either the high-order or low-order
bit of the source register.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 11
PIC12F683
2.2.2.2
OPTION Register
Note:
The OPTION register is a readable and writable
register, which contains various control bits to
configure:
•
•
•
•
TMR0/WDT prescaler
External GP2/INT interrupt
TMR0
Weak pull-ups on GPIO
REGISTER 2-2:
To achieve a 1:1 prescaler assignment for
Timer0, assign the prescaler to the WDT
by setting PSA bit of the OPTION register
to ‘1’ See Section 5.1.3 “Software Programmable Prescaler”.
OPTION_REG: OPTION REGISTER
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
GPPU
INTEDG
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
GPPU: GPIO Pull-up Enable bit
1 = GPIO pull-ups are disabled
0 = GPIO pull-ups are enabled by individual PORT latch values in WPU register
bit 6
INTEDG: Interrupt Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge of INT pin
0 = Interrupt on falling edge of INT pin
bit 5
T0CS: Timer0 Clock Source Select bit
1 = Transition on T0CKI pin
0 = Internal instruction cycle clock (FOSC/4)
bit 4
T0SE: Timer0 Source Edge Select bit
1 = Increment on high-to-low transition on T0CKI pin
0 = Increment on low-to-high transition on T0CKI pin
bit 3
PSA: Prescaler Assignment bit
1 = Prescaler is assigned to the WDT
0 = Prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module
bit 2-0
PS<2:0>: Prescaler Rate Select bits
BIT VALUE
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
Note 1:
TIMER0 RATE WDT RATE
1:2
1:4
1:8
1 : 16
1 : 32
1 : 64
1 : 128
1 : 256
1:1
1:2
1:4
1:8
1 : 16
1 : 32
1 : 64
1 : 128
A dedicated 16-bit WDT postscaler is available. See Section 12.6 “Watchdog Timer (WDT)” for more
information.
DS41211D-page 12
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
2.2.2.3
INTCON Register
Note:
The INTCON register is a readable and writable
register, which contains the various enable and flag bits
for TMR0 register overflow, GPIO change and external
GP2/INT pin interrupts.
REGISTER 2-3:
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit or the global
enable bit, GIE of the INTCON register.
User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to
enabling an interrupt.
INTCON: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
GIE: Global Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables all unmasked interrupts
0 = Disables all interrupts
bit 6
PEIE: Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables all unmasked peripheral interrupts
0 = Disables all peripheral interrupts
bit 5
T0IE: Timer0 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the Timer0 interrupt
0 = Disables the Timer0 interrupt
bit 4
INTE: GP2/INT External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the GP2/INT external interrupt
0 = Disables the GP2/INT external interrupt
bit 3
GPIE: GPIO Change Interrupt Enable bit(1)
1 = Enables the GPIO change interrupt
0 = Disables the GPIO change interrupt
bit 2
T0IF: Timer0 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit(2)
1 = Timer0 register has overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = Timer0 register did not overflow
bit 1
INTF: GP2/INT External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The GP2/INT external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The GP2/INT external interrupt did not occur
bit 0
GPIF: GPIO Change Interrupt Flag bit
1 = When at least one of the GPIO <5:0> pins changed state (must be cleared in software)
0 = None of the GPIO <5:0> pins have changed state
Note 1:
2:
IOC register must also be enabled.
T0IF bit is set when TMR0 rolls over. TMR0 is unchanged on Reset and should be initialized before
clearing T0IF bit.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 13
PIC12F683
2.2.2.4
PIE1 Register
The PIE1 register contains the interrupt enable bits, as
shown in Register 2-4.
REGISTER 2-4:
Note:
Bit PEIE of the INTCON register must be
set to enable any peripheral interrupt.
PIE1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
EEIE: EE Write Complete Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the EE write complete interrupt
0 = Disables the EE write complete interrupt
bit 6
ADIE: A/D Converter (ADC) Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the ADC interrupt
0 = Disables the ADC interrupt
bit 5
CCP1IE: CCP1 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the CCP1 interrupt
0 = Disables the CCP1 interrupt
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3
CMIE: Comparator Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the Comparator 1 interrupt
0 = Disables the Comparator 1 interrupt
bit 2
OSFIE: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the oscillator fail interrupt
0 = Disables the oscillator fail interrupt
bit 1
TMR2IE: Timer2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the Timer2 to PR2 match interrupt
0 = Disables the Timer2 to PR2 match interrupt
bit 0
TMR1IE: Timer1 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the Timer1 overflow interrupt
0 = Disables the Timer1 overflow interrupt
DS41211D-page 14
x = Bit is unknown
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
2.2.2.5
PIR1 Register
The PIR1 register contains the interrupt flag bits, as
shown in Register 2-5.
REGISTER 2-5:
Note:
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit or the global
enable bit, GIE of the INTCON register.
User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to
enabling an interrupt.
PIR1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
EEIF: EEPROM Write Operation Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The write operation completed (must be cleared in software)
0 = The write operation has not completed or has not been started
bit 6
ADIF: A/D Interrupt Flag bit
1 = A/D conversion complete
0 = A/D conversion has not completed or has not been started
bit 5
CCP1IF: CCP1 Interrupt Flag bit
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR1 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1 register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR1 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1 register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Unused in this mode
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3
CMIF: Comparator Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Comparator 1 output has changed (must be cleared in software)
0 = Comparator 1 output has not changed
bit 2
OSFIF: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Flag bit
1 = System oscillator failed, clock input has changed to INTOSC (must be cleared in software)
0 = System clock operating
bit 1
TMR2IF: Timer2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Timer2 to PR2 match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = Timer2 to PR2 match has not occurred
bit 0
TMR1IF: Timer1 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Timer1 register overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = Timer1 has not overflowed
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 15
PIC12F683
2.2.2.6
PCON Register
The Power Control (PCON) register contains flag bits
(see Table 12-2) to differentiate between a:
•
•
•
•
Power-on Reset (POR)
Brown-out Reset (BOR)
Watchdog Timer Reset (WDT)
External MCLR Reset
The PCON register also controls the Ultra Low-Power
Wake-up and software enable of the BOR.
The PCON register bits are shown in Register 2-6.
REGISTER 2-6:
PCON: POWER CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-1
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-x
—
—
ULPWUE
SBOREN
—
—
POR
BOR
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
ULPWUE: Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up Enable bit
1 = Ultra Low-Power Wake-up enabled
0 = Ultra Low-Power Wake-up disabled
bit 4
SBOREN: Software BOR Enable bit(1)
1 = BOR enabled
0 = BOR disabled
bit 3-2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 1
POR: Power-on Reset Status bit
1 = No Power-on Reset occurred
0 = A Power-on Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset occurs)
bit 0
BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit
1 = No Brown-out Reset occurred
0 = A Brown-out Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset or Brown-out Reset
occurs)
Note 1:
Set BOREN<1:0> = 01 in the Configuration Word register for this bit to control the BOR.
DS41211D-page 16
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
2.3
PCL and PCLATH
The Program Counter (PC) is 13 bits wide. The low byte
comes from the PCL register, which is a readable and
writable register. The high byte (PC<12:8>) is not
directly readable or writable and comes from PCLATH.
On any Reset, the PC is cleared. Figure 2-3 shows the
two situations for the loading of the PC. The upper
example in Figure 2-3 shows how the PC is loaded on a
write to PCL (PCLATH<4:0> → PCH). The lower example in Figure 2-3 shows how the PC is loaded during a
CALL or GOTO instruction (PCLATH<4:3> → PCH).
FIGURE 2-3:
12
8
Instruction with
0 PCL as
Destination
7
8
PCLATH<4:0>
ALU Result
PCLATH
PCH
11 10
PCL
8
0
7
PC
GOTO, CALL
2
PCLATH<4:3>
11
OPCODE<10:0>
PCLATH
2.3.1
COMPUTED GOTO
A computed GOTO is accomplished by adding an offset
to the program counter (ADDWF PCL). When performing a table read using a computed GOTO method, care
should be exercised if the table location crosses a PCL
memory boundary (each 256-byte block). Refer to the
Application Note AN556, “Implementing a Table Read”
(DS00556).
2.3.2
2: There are no instructions/mnemonics
called PUSH or POP. These are actions
that occur from the execution of the
CALL, RETURN, RETLW and RETFIE
instructions or the vectoring to an
interrupt address.
2.4
PCL
PC
12
Note 1: There are no Status bits to indicate stack
overflow or stack underflow conditions.
LOADING OF PC IN
DIFFERENT SITUATIONS
PCH
5
The stack operates as a circular buffer. This means that
after the stack has been PUSHed eight times, the ninth
push overwrites the value that was stored from the first
push. The tenth push overwrites the second push (and
so on).
Indirect Addressing, INDF and
FSR Registers
The INDF register is not a physical register. Addressing
the INDF register will cause indirect addressing.
Indirect addressing is possible by using the INDF
register. Any instruction using the INDF register
actually accesses data pointed to by the File Select
Register (FSR). Reading INDF itself indirectly will
produce 00h. Writing to the INDF register indirectly
results in a no operation (although Status bits may be
affected). An effective 9-bit address is obtained by
concatenating the 8-bit FSR register and the IRP bit of
the STATUS register, as shown in Figure 2-4.
A simple program to clear RAM location 20h-2Fh using
indirect addressing is shown in Example 2-1.
EXAMPLE 2-1:
MOVLW
MOVWF
NEXT
CLRF
INCF
BTFSS
GOTO
CONTINUE
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
0x20
FSR
INDF
FSR
FSR,4
NEXT
;initialize pointer
;to RAM
;clear INDF register
;inc pointer
;all done?
;no clear next
;yes continue
STACK
The PIC12F683 family has an 8-level x 13-bit wide
hardware stack (see Figure 2-1). The stack space is
not part of either program or data space and the Stack
Pointer is not readable or writable. The PC is PUSHed
onto the stack when a CALL instruction is executed or
an interrupt causes a branch. The stack is POPed in
the event of a RETURN, RETLW or a RETFIE instruction
execution. PCLATH is not affected by a PUSH or POP
operation.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 17
PIC12F683
FIGURE 2-4:
DIRECT/INDIRECT ADDRESSING PIC12F683
Direct Addressing
RP1
(1)
RP0
6
Bank Select
Indirect Addressing
From Opcode
IRP(1)
0
7
Bank Select
Location Select
00
01
10
File Select Register
0
Location Select
11
00h
180h
Data
Memory
Not Used
7Fh
1FFh
Bank 0
Bank 1
Bank 2
Bank 3
For memory map detail, see Figure 2-2.
Note 1:
The RP1 and IRP bits are reserved; always maintain these bits clear.
DS41211D-page 18
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
3.0
OSCILLATOR MODULE (WITH
FAIL-SAFE CLOCK MONITOR)
The Oscillator module can be configured in one of eight
clock modes.
3.1
Overview
1.
2.
3.
The Oscillator module has a wide variety of clock
sources and selection features that allow it to be used
in a wide range of applications while maximizing performance and minimizing power consumption. Figure 3-1
illustrates a block diagram of the Oscillator module.
4.
5.
Clock sources can be configured from external
oscillators, quartz crystal resonators, ceramic resonators
and Resistor-Capacitor (RC) circuits. In addition, the
system clock source can be configured from one of two
internal oscillators, with a choice of speeds selectable via
software. Additional clock features include:
6.
7.
8.
• Selectable system clock source between external
or internal via software.
• Two-Speed Start-up mode, which minimizes
latency between external oscillator start-up and
code execution.
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) designed to
detect a failure of the external clock source (LP,
XT, HS, EC or RC modes) and switch
automatically to the internal oscillator.
FIGURE 3-1:
EC – External clock with I/O on OSC2/CLKOUT.
LP – 32 kHz Low-Power Crystal mode.
XT – Medium Gain Crystal or Ceramic
Resonator Oscillator mode.
HS – High Gain Crystal or Ceramic Resonator
mode.
RC – External Resistor-Capacitor (RC) with
FOSC/4 output on OSC2/CLKOUT.
RCIO – External Resistor-Capacitor (RC) with
I/O on OSC2/CLKOUT.
INTOSC – Internal oscillator with FOSC/4 output
on OSC2 and I/O on OSC1/CLKIN.
INTOSCIO – Internal oscillator with I/O on
OSC1/CLKIN and OSC2/CLKOUT.
Clock Source modes are configured by the FOSC<2:0>
bits in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG). The
internal clock can be generated from two internal
oscillators. The HFINTOSC is a calibrated
high-frequency oscillator. The LFINTOSC is an
uncalibrated low-frequency oscillator.
PIC® MCU CLOCK SOURCE BLOCK DIAGRAM
FOSC<2:0>
(Configuration Word Register)
SCS<0>
(OSCCON Register)
External Oscillator
OSC2
Sleep
MUX
LP, XT, HS, RC, RCIO, EC
OSC1
IRCF<2:0>
(OSCCON Register)
8 MHz
Internal Oscillator
4 MHz
System Clock
(CPU and Peripherals)
INTOSC
111
110
101
1 MHz
100
500 kHz
250 kHz
125 kHz
LFINTOSC
31 kHz
31 kHz
011
MUX
HFINTOSC
8 MHz
Postscaler
2 MHz
010
001
000
Power-up Timer (PWRT)
Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 19
PIC12F683
3.2
Oscillator Control
The Oscillator Control (OSCCON) register (Figure 3-1)
controls the system clock and frequency selection
options. The OSCCON register contains the following
bits:
• Frequency selection bits (IRCF)
• Frequency Status bits (HTS, LTS)
• System clock control bits (OSTS, SCS)
REGISTER 3-1:
OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-0
R-1
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
—
IRCF2
IRCF1
IRCF0
OSTS(1)
HTS
LTS
SCS
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-4
IRCF<2:0>: Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits
111 = 8 MHz
110 = 4 MHz (default)
101 = 2 MHz
100 = 1 MHz
011 = 500 kHz
010 = 250 kHz
001 = 125 kHz
000 = 31 kHz (LFINTOSC)
bit 3
OSTS: Oscillator Start-up Time-out Status bit(1)
1 = Device is running from the external clock defined by FOSC<2:0> of the Configuration Word register
0 = Device is running from the internal oscillator (HFINTOSC or LFINTOSC)
bit 2
HTS: HFINTOSC Status bit (High Frequency – 8 MHz to 125 kHz)
1 = HFINTOSC is stable
0 = HFINTOSC is not stable
bit 1
LTS: LFINTOSC Stable bit (Low Frequency – 31 kHz)
1 = LFINTOSC is stable
0 = LFINTOSC is not stable
bit 0
SCS: System Clock Select bit
1 = Internal oscillator is used for system clock
0 = Clock source defined by FOSC<2:0> of the Configuration Word register
Note 1:
Bit resets to ‘0’ with Two-Speed Start-up and LP, XT or HS selected as the Oscillator mode or Fail-Safe
mode is enabled.
DS41211D-page 20
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
3.3
Clock Source Modes
Clock Source modes can be classified as external or
internal.
External Clock Modes
3.4.1
OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER (OST)
If the Oscillator module is configured for LP, XT or HS
modes, the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) counts
1024 oscillations from OSC1. This occurs following a
Power-on Reset (POR) and when the Power-up Timer
(PWRT) has expired (if configured), or a wake-up from
Sleep. During this time, the program counter does not
increment and program execution is suspended. The
OST ensures that the oscillator circuit, using a quartz
crystal resonator or ceramic resonator, has started and
is providing a stable system clock to the Oscillator
module. When switching between clock sources, a
delay is required to allow the new clock to stabilize.
These oscillator delays are shown in Table 3-1.
• External Clock modes rely on external circuitry for
the clock source. Examples are: Oscillator modules (EC mode), quartz crystal resonators or
ceramic resonators (LP, XT and HS modes) and
Resistor-Capacitor (RC) mode circuits.
• Internal clock sources are contained internally
within the Oscillator module. The Oscillator
module has two internal oscillators: the 8 MHz
High-Frequency Internal Oscillator (HFINTOSC)
and the 31 kHz Low-Frequency Internal Oscillator
(LFINTOSC).
The system clock can be selected between external or
internal clock sources via the System Clock Select
(SCS) bit of the OSCCON register. See Section 3.6
“Clock Switching” for additional information.
TABLE 3-1:
3.4
In order to minimize latency between external oscillator
start-up and code execution, the Two-Speed Clock
Start-up mode can be selected (see Section 3.7
“Two-Speed Clock Start-up Mode”).
OSCILLATOR DELAY EXAMPLES
Switch From
Switch To
Frequency
Oscillator Delay
Sleep/POR
LFINTOSC
HFINTOSC
31 kHz
125 kHz to 8 MHz
Sleep/POR
EC, RC
DC – 20 MHz
2 instruction cycles
LFINTOSC (31 kHz)
EC, RC
DC – 20 MHz
1 cycle of each
Oscillator Warm-Up Delay (TWARM)
Sleep/POR
LP, XT, HS
32 kHz to 20 MHz
1024 Clock Cycles (OST)
LFINTOSC (31 kHz)
HFINTOSC
125 kHz to 8 MHz
1 μs (approx.)
3.4.2
EC MODE
The External Clock (EC) mode allows an externally
generated logic level as the system clock source. When
operating in this mode, an external clock source is
connected to the OSC1 input and the OSC2 is available
for general purpose I/O. Figure 3-2 shows the pin
connections for EC mode.
The Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) is disabled when
EC mode is selected. Therefore, there is no delay in
operation after a Power-on Reset (POR) or wake-up
from Sleep. Because the PIC® MCU design is fully
static, stopping the external clock input will have the
effect of halting the device while leaving all data intact.
Upon restarting the external clock, the device will
resume operation as if no time had elapsed.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
FIGURE 3-2:
EXTERNAL CLOCK (EC)
MODE OPERATION
OSC1/CLKIN
Clock from
Ext. System
PIC® MCU
I/O
Note 1:
OSC2/CLKOUT(1)
Alternate pin functions are listed in the
Device Overview.
DS41211D-page 21
PIC12F683
3.4.3
LP, XT, HS MODES
The LP, XT and HS modes support the use of quartz
crystal resonators or ceramic resonators connected to
OSC1 and OSC2 (Figure 3-3). The mode selects a low,
medium or high gain setting of the internal
inverter-amplifier to support various resonator types
and speed.
LP Oscillator mode selects the lowest gain setting of the
internal inverter-amplifier. LP mode current consumption
is the least of the three modes. This mode is designed to
drive only 32.768 kHz tuning-fork type crystals (watch
crystals).
Note 1: Quartz crystal characteristics vary according
to type, package and manufacturer. The
user should consult the manufacturer data
sheets for specifications and recommended
application.
2: Always verify oscillator performance over
the VDD and temperature range that is
expected for the application.
3: For oscillator design assistance, reference
the following Microchip Applications Notes:
• AN826, “Crystal Oscillator Basics and
Crystal Selection for rfPIC® and PIC®
Devices” (DS00826)
• AN849, “Basic PIC® Oscillator Design”
(DS00849)
• AN943, “Practical PIC® Oscillator
Analysis and Design” (DS00943)
• AN949, “Making Your Oscillator Work”
(DS00949)
XT Oscillator mode selects the intermediate gain
setting of the internal inverter-amplifier. XT mode
current consumption is the medium of the three modes.
This mode is best suited to drive resonators with a
medium drive level specification.
HS Oscillator mode selects the highest gain setting of the
internal inverter-amplifier. HS mode current consumption
is the highest of the three modes. This mode is best
suited for resonators that require a high drive setting.
Figure 3-3 and Figure 3-4 show typical circuits for
quartz crystal and ceramic resonators, respectively.
FIGURE 3-3:
CERAMIC RESONATOR
OPERATION
(XT OR HS MODE)
QUARTZ CRYSTAL
OPERATION (LP, XT OR
HS MODE)
OSC1/CLKIN
C1
PIC® MCU
OSC1/CLKIN
C1
PIC® MCU
To Internal
Logic
RP(3)
RF(2)
Sleep
To Internal
Logic
Quartz
Crystal
C2
FIGURE 3-4:
RS(1)
RF(2)
Sleep
OSC2/CLKOUT
Note 1:
A series resistor (RS) may be required for
quartz crystals with low drive level.
2:
The value of RF varies with the Oscillator mode
selected (typically between 2 MΩ to 10 MΩ).
DS41211D-page 22
C2 Ceramic
RS(1)
Resonator
OSC2/CLKOUT
Note 1: A series resistor (RS) may be required for
ceramic resonators with low drive level.
2: The value of RF varies with the Oscillator mode
selected (typically between 2 MΩ to 10 MΩ).
3: An additional parallel feedback resistor (RP)
may be required for proper ceramic resonator
operation.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
3.4.4
EXTERNAL RC MODES
3.5
The external Resistor-Capacitor (RC) modes support
the use of an external RC circuit. This allows the
designer maximum flexibility in frequency choice while
keeping costs to a minimum when clock accuracy is not
required. There are two modes: RC and RCIO.
In RC mode, the RC circuit connects to OSC1.
OSC2/CLKOUT outputs the RC oscillator frequency
divided by 4. This signal may be used to provide a clock
for external circuitry, synchronization, calibration, test
or other application requirements. Figure 3-5 shows
the external RC mode connections.
FIGURE 3-5:
VDD
EXTERNAL RC MODES
PIC® MCU
REXT
OSC1/CLKIN
Internal
Clock
CEXT
VSS
FOSC/4 or
I/O(2)
OSC2/CLKOUT(1)
Recommended values: 10 kΩ ≤ REXT ≤ 100 kΩ, <3V
3 kΩ ≤ REXT ≤ 100 kΩ, 3-5V
CEXT > 20 pF, 2-5V
Note 1:
2:
Alternate pin functions are listed in the Device
Overview.
Output depends upon RC or RCIO clock mode.
In RCIO mode, the RC circuit is connected to OSC1.
OSC2 becomes an additional general purpose I/O pin.
The RC oscillator frequency is a function of the supply
voltage, the resistor (REXT) and capacitor (CEXT) values
and the operating temperature. Other factors affecting
the oscillator frequency are:
• threshold voltage variation
• component tolerances
• packaging variations in capacitance
The user also needs to take into account variation due
to tolerance of external RC components used.
Internal Clock Modes
The Oscillator module has two independent, internal
oscillators that can be configured or selected as the
system clock source.
1.
2.
The HFINTOSC (High-Frequency Internal
Oscillator) is factory calibrated and operates at
8 MHz. The frequency of the HFINTOSC can be
user-adjusted via software using the OSCTUNE
register (Register 3-2).
The LFINTOSC (Low-Frequency Internal
Oscillator) is uncalibrated and operates at 31 kHz.
The system clock speed can be selected via software
using the Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits
IRCF<2:0> of the OSCCON register.
The system clock can be selected between external or
internal clock sources via the System Clock Selection
(SCS) bit of the OSCCON register. See Section 3.6
“Clock Switching” for more information.
3.5.1
INTOSC AND INTOSCIO MODES
The INTOSC and INTOSCIO modes configure the
internal oscillators as the system clock source when
the device is programmed using the oscillator selection
or the FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration Word
register (CONFIG). See Section 12.0 “Special
Features of the CPU” for more information.
In INTOSC mode, OSC1/CLKIN is available for general
purpose I/O. OSC2/CLKOUT outputs the selected
internal oscillator frequency divided by 4. The CLKOUT
signal may be used to provide a clock for external
circuitry, synchronization, calibration, test or other
application requirements.
In INTOSCIO mode, OSC1/CLKIN and OSC2/CLKOUT
are available for general purpose I/O.
3.5.2
HFINTOSC
The High-Frequency Internal Oscillator (HFINTOSC) is
a factory calibrated 8 MHz internal clock source. The
frequency of the HFINTOSC can be altered via
software using the OSCTUNE register (Register 3-2).
The output of the HFINTOSC connects to a postscaler
and multiplexer (see Figure 3-1). One of seven
frequencies can be selected via software using the
IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register. See
Section 3.5.4 “Frequency Select Bits (IRCF)” for
more information.
The HFINTOSC is enabled by selecting any frequency
between 8 MHz and 125 kHz by setting the IRCF<2:0>
bits of the OSCCON register ≠ 000. Then, set the
System Clock Source (SCS) bit of the OSCCON
register to ‘1’ or enable Two-Speed Start-up by setting
the IESO bit in the Configuration Word register
(CONFIG) to ‘1’.
The HF Internal Oscillator (HTS) bit of the OSCCON
register indicates whether the HFINTOSC is stable or not.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 23
PIC12F683
3.5.2.1
OSCTUNE Register
The HFINTOSC is factory calibrated but can be
adjusted in software by writing to the OSCTUNE
register (Register 3-2).
The default value of the OSCTUNE register is ‘0’. The
value is a 5-bit two’s complement number.
REGISTER 3-2:
When the OSCTUNE register is modified, the
HFINTOSC frequency will begin shifting to the new
frequency. Code execution continues during this shift.
There is no indication that the shift has occurred.
OSCTUNE does not affect the LFINTOSC frequency.
Operation of features that depend on the LFINTOSC
clock source frequency, such as the Power-up Timer
(PWRT), Watchdog Timer (WDT), Fail-Safe Clock
Monitor (FSCM) and peripherals, are not affected by the
change in frequency.
OSCTUNE: OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
—
TUN4
TUN3
TUN2
TUN1
TUN0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4-0
TUN<4:0>: Frequency Tuning bits
01111 = Maximum frequency
01110 =
•
•
•
00001 =
00000 = Oscillator module is running at the calibrated frequency.
11111 =
•
•
•
10000 = Minimum frequency
DS41211D-page 24
x = Bit is unknown
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
3.5.3
LFINTOSC
The Low-Frequency Internal Oscillator (LFINTOSC) is
an uncalibrated 31 kHz internal clock source.
The output of the LFINTOSC connects to a postscaler
and multiplexer (see Figure 3-1). Select 31 kHz, via
software, using the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON
register. See Section 3.5.4 “Frequency Select Bits
(IRCF)” for more information. The LFINTOSC is also the
frequency for the Power-up Timer (PWRT), Watchdog
Timer (WDT) and Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM).
The LFINTOSC is enabled by selecting 31 kHz
(IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register = 000) as the
system clock source (SCS bit of the OSCCON
register = 1), or when any of the following are enabled:
• Two-Speed Start-up IESO bit of the Configuration
Word register = 1 and IRCF<2:0> bits of the
OSCCON register = 000
• Power-up Timer (PWRT)
• Watchdog Timer (WDT)
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM)
The LF Internal Oscillator (LTS) bit of the OSCCON
register indicates whether the LFINTOSC is stable or
not.
3.5.4
FREQUENCY SELECT BITS (IRCF)
The output of the 8 MHz HFINTOSC and 31 kHz
LFINTOSC connects to a postscaler and multiplexer
(see Figure 3-1). The Internal Oscillator Frequency
Select bits IRCF<2:0> of the OSCCON register select
the frequency output of the internal oscillators. One of
eight frequencies can be selected via software:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
8 MHz
4 MHz (Default after Reset)
2 MHz
1 MHz
500 kHz
250 kHz
125 kHz
31 kHz (LFINTOSC)
Note:
3.5.5
HF AND LF INTOSC CLOCK
SWITCH TIMING
When switching between the LFINTOSC and the
HFINTOSC, the new oscillator may already be shut
down to save power (see Figure 3-6). If this is the case,
there is a delay after the IRCF<2:0> bits of the
OSCCON register are modified before the frequency
selection takes place. The LTS and HTS bits of the
OSCCON register will reflect the current active status
of the LFINTOSC and HFINTOSC oscillators. The
timing of a frequency selection is as follows:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON register are
modified.
If the new clock is shut down, a clock start-up
delay is started.
Clock switch circuitry waits for a falling edge of
the current clock.
CLKOUT is held low and the clock switch
circuitry waits for a rising edge in the new clock.
CLKOUT is now connected with the new clock.
LTS and HTS bits of the OSCCON register are
updated as required.
Clock switch is complete.
See Figure 3-1 for more details.
If the internal oscillator speed selected is between
8 MHz and 125 kHz, there is no start-up delay before
the new frequency is selected. This is because the old
and new frequencies are derived from the HFINTOSC
via the postscaler and multiplexer.
Start-up delay specifications are located in the
Electrical Specifications Chapter of this data sheet,
under AC Specifications (Oscillator Module).
Following any Reset, the IRCF<2:0> bits of
the OSCCON register are set to ‘110’ and
the frequency selection is set to 4 MHz.
The user can modify the IRCF bits to
select a different frequency.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 25
PIC12F683
FIGURE 3-6:
INTERNAL OSCILLATOR SWITCH TIMING
LF(1)
HF
HFINTOSC
LFINTOSC (FSCM and WDT disabled)
HFINTOSC
Start-up Time
2-cycle Sync
Running
LFINTOSC
≠0
IRCF <2:0>
=0
System Clock
Note 1:
When going from LF to HF.
HFINTOSC
LFINTOSC (Either FSCM or WDT enabled)
HFINTOSC
2-cycle Sync
Running
LFINTOSC
≠0
IRCF <2:0>
=0
System Clock
LFINTOSC
HFINTOSC
LFINTOSC turns off unless WDT or FSCM is enabled
LFINTOSC
Start-up Time 2-cycle Sync
Running
HFINTOSC
IRCF <2:0>
=0
≠0
System Clock
DS41211D-page 26
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
3.6
Clock Switching
The system clock source can be switched between
external and internal clock sources via software using
the System Clock Select (SCS) bit of the OSCCON
register.
3.6.1
SYSTEM CLOCK SELECT (SCS) BIT
The System Clock Select (SCS) bit of the OSCCON
register selects the system clock source that is used for
the CPU and peripherals.
• When the SCS bit of the OSCCON register = 0,
the system clock source is determined by
configuration of the FOSC<2:0> bits in the
Configuration Word register (CONFIG).
• When the SCS bit of the OSCCON register = 1,
the system clock source is chosen by the internal
oscillator frequency selected by the IRCF<2:0>
bits of the OSCCON register. After a Reset, the
SCS bit of the OSCCON register is always
cleared.
Note:
3.6.2
Any automatic clock switch, which may
occur from Two-Speed Start-up or Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor, does not update the SCS bit
of the OSCCON register. The user can
monitor the OSTS bit of the OSCCON
register to determine the current system
clock source.
OSCILLATOR START-UP TIME-OUT
STATUS (OSTS) BIT
The Oscillator Start-up Time-out Status (OSTS) bit of
the OSCCON register indicates whether the system
clock is running from the external clock source, as
defined by the FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration
Word register (CONFIG), or from the internal clock
source. In particular, OSTS indicates that the Oscillator
Start-up Timer (OST) has timed out for LP, XT or HS
modes.
3.7
Two-Speed Clock Start-up Mode
Two-Speed Start-up mode provides additional power
savings by minimizing the latency between external
oscillator start-up and code execution. In applications
that make heavy use of the Sleep mode, Two-Speed
Start-up will remove the external oscillator start-up
time from the time spent awake and can reduce the
overall power consumption of the device.
When the Oscillator module is configured for LP, XT or
HS modes, the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) is
enabled (see Section 3.4.1 “Oscillator Start-up Timer
(OST)”). The OST will suspend program execution until
1024 oscillations are counted. Two-Speed Start-up
mode minimizes the delay in code execution by
operating from the internal oscillator as the OST is
counting. When the OST count reaches 1024 and the
OSTS bit of the OSCCON register is set, program
execution switches to the external oscillator.
3.7.1
TWO-SPEED START-UP MODE
CONFIGURATION
Two-Speed Start-up mode is configured by the
following settings:
• IESO (of the Configuration Word register) = 1;
Internal/External Switchover bit (Two-Speed
Start-up mode enabled).
• SCS (of the OSCCON register) = 0.
• FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration Word
register (CONFIG) configured for LP, XT or HS
mode.
Two-Speed Start-up mode is entered after:
• Power-on Reset (POR) and, if enabled, after
Power-up Timer (PWRT) has expired, or
• Wake-up from Sleep.
If the external clock oscillator is configured to be
anything other than LP, XT or HS mode, then
Two-Speed Start-up is disabled. This is because the
external clock oscillator does not require any
stabilization time after POR or an exit from Sleep.
3.7.2
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
TWO-SPEED START-UP
SEQUENCE
Wake-up from Power-on Reset or Sleep.
Instructions begin execution by the internal
oscillator at the frequency set in the IRCF<2:0>
bits of the OSCCON register.
OST enabled to count 1024 clock cycles.
OST timed out, wait for falling edge of the
internal oscillator.
OSTS is set.
System clock held low until the next falling edge
of new clock (LP, XT or HS mode).
System clock is switched to external clock
source.
This mode allows the application to wake-up from
Sleep, perform a few instructions using the INTOSC
as the clock source and go back to Sleep without
waiting for the primary oscillator to become stable.
Note:
Executing a SLEEP instruction will abort
the oscillator start-up time and will cause
the OSTS bit of the OSCCON register to
remain clear.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 27
PIC12F683
3.7.3
CHECKING TWO-SPEED CLOCK
STATUS
Checking the state of the OSTS bit of the OSCCON
register will confirm if the microcontroller is running
from the external clock source, as defined by the
FOSC<2:0> bits in the Configuration Word register
(CONFIG), or the internal oscillator.
FIGURE 3-7:
TWO-SPEED START-UP
HFINTOSC
TOST
OSC1
0
1
1022 1023
OSC2
Program Counter
PC - N
PC
PC + 1
System Clock
DS41211D-page 28
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
3.8
3.8.3
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) allows the device
to continue operating should the external oscillator fail.
The FSCM can detect oscillator failure any time after
the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) has expired. The
FSCM is enabled by setting the FCMEN bit in the
Configuration Word register (CONFIG). The FSCM is
applicable to all external oscillator modes (LP, XT, HS,
EC, RC and RCIO).
FIGURE 3-8:
FSCM BLOCK DIAGRAM
Clock Monitor
Latch
External
Clock
LFINTOSC
Oscillator
÷ 64
31 kHz
(~32 μs)
488 Hz
(~2 ms)
S
Q
R
Q
The Fail-Safe condition is cleared after a Reset,
executing a SLEEP instruction or toggling the SCS bit
of the OSCCON register. When the SCS bit is toggled,
the OST is restarted. While the OST is running, the
device continues to operate from the INTOSC selected
in OSCCON. When the OST times out, the Fail-Safe
condition is cleared and the device will be operating
from the external clock source. The Fail-Safe condition
must be cleared before the OSFIF flag can be cleared.
3.8.4
3.8.1
Clock
Failure
Detected
FAIL-SAFE DETECTION
The FSCM module detects a failed oscillator by
comparing the external oscillator to the FSCM sample
clock. The sample clock is generated by dividing the
LFINTOSC by 64. See Figure 3-8. Inside the fail
detector block is a latch. The external clock sets the
latch on each falling edge of the external clock. The
sample clock clears the latch on each rising edge of the
sample clock. A failure is detected when an entire
half-cycle of the sample clock elapses before the
primary clock goes low.
3.8.2
RESET OR WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP
The FSCM is designed to detect an oscillator failure
after the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) has expired.
The OST is used after waking up from Sleep and after
any type of Reset. The OST is not used with the EC or
RC Clock modes so that the FSCM will be active as
soon as the Reset or wake-up has completed. When
the FSCM is enabled, the Two-Speed Start-up is also
enabled. Therefore, the device will always be executing
code while the OST is operating.
Note:
Sample Clock
FAIL-SAFE CONDITION CLEARING
Due to the wide range of oscillator start-up
times, the Fail-Safe circuit is not active
during oscillator start-up (i.e., after exiting
Reset or Sleep). After an appropriate
amount of time, the user should check the
OSTS bit of the OSCCON register to verify
the oscillator start-up and that the system
clock
switchover
has
successfully
completed.
FAIL-SAFE OPERATION
When the external clock fails, the FSCM switches the
device clock to an internal clock source and sets the bit
flag OSFIF of the PIR1 register. Setting this flag will
generate an interrupt if the OSFIE bit of the PIE1
register is also set. The device firmware can then take
steps to mitigate the problems that may arise from a
failed clock. The system clock will continue to be
sourced from the internal clock source until the device
firmware successfully restarts the external oscillator
and switches back to external operation.
The internal clock source chosen by the FSCM is
determined by the IRCF<2:0> bits of the OSCCON
register. This allows the internal oscillator to be
configured before a failure occurs.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 29
PIC12F683
FIGURE 3-9:
FSCM TIMING DIAGRAM
Sample Clock
Oscillator
Failure
System
Clock
Output
Clock Monitor Output
(Q)
Failure
Detected
OSCFIF
Test
Note:
Test
Test
The system clock is normally at a much higher frequency than the sample clock. The relative frequencies in
this example have been chosen for clarity.
TABLE 3-2:
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH CLOCK SOURCES
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Value on
all other
Resets(1)
CONFIG(2)
CPD
CP
MCLRE
PWRTE
WDTE
FOSC2
FOSC1
FOSC0
—
—
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000
0000 000x
OSCCON
—
IRCF2
IRCF1
IRCF0
OSTS
HTS
LTS
SCS
-110 x000
-110 x000
Name
OSCTUNE
PIE1
PIR1
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
—
—
—
TUN4
TUN3
TUN2
TUN1
TUN0
---0 0000
---u uuuu
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
000- 0000
000- 0000
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
000- 0000
000- 0000
x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by oscillators.
Other (non Power-up) Resets include MCLR Reset and Watchdog Timer Reset during normal operation.
See Configuration Word register (Register 12-1) for operation of all register bits.
DS41211D-page 30
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
4.0
GPIO PORT
There are as many as six general purpose I/O pins
available. Depending on which peripherals are
enabled, some or all of the pins may not be available as
general purpose I/O. In general, when a peripheral is
enabled, the associated pin may not be used as a
general purpose I/O pin.
4.1
GPIO and the TRISIO Registers
The TRISIO register controls the direction of the GPIO
pins, even when they are being used as analog inputs.
The user must ensure the bits in the TRISIO register
are maintained set when using them as analog inputs.
I/O pins configured as analog input always read ‘0’.
Note:
GPIO is a 6-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding data direction register is TRISIO.
Setting a TRISIO bit (= 1) will make the corresponding
GPIO pin an input (i.e., put the corresponding output
driver in a High-Impedance mode). Clearing a TRISIO
bit (= 0) will make the corresponding GPIO pin an
output (i.e., put the contents of the output latch on the
selected pin). An exception is GP3, which is input only
and its TRISIO bit will always read as ‘1’. Example 4-1
shows how to initialize GPIO.
Reading the GPIO register reads the status of the pins,
whereas writing to it will write to the PORT latch. All
write operations are read-modify-write operations.
REGISTER 4-1:
Therefore, a write to a port implies that the port pins are
read, this value is modified and then written to the
PORT data latch. GP3 reads ‘0’ when MCLRE = 1.
The ANSEL and CMCON0 registers must
be initialized to configure an analog
channel as a digital input. Pins configured
as analog inputs will read ‘0’.
EXAMPLE 4-1:
BANKSEL
CLRF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BANKSEL
CLRF
MOVLW
MOVWF
GPIO
GPIO
07h
CMCON0
ANSEL
ANSEL
0Ch
TRISIO
INITIALIZING GPIO
;
;Init GPIO
;Set GP<2:0> to
;digital I/O
;
;digital I/O
;Set GP<3:2> as inputs
;and set GP<5:4,1:0>
;as outputs
GPIO: GENERAL PURPOSE I/O REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-0
R-x
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
GP5
GP4
GP3
GP2
GP1
GP0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-0
GP<5:0>: GPIO I/O Pin bit
1 = Port pin is > VIH
0 = Port pin is < VIL
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
DS41211D-page 31
PIC12F683
REGISTER 4-2:
TRISIO GPIO TRI-STATE REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
—
—
TRISIO5(2,3)
TRISIO4(2)
TRISIO3(1)
TRISIO2
TRISIO1
TRISIO0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5:4
TRISIO<5:4>: GPIO Tri-State Control bit
1 = GPIO pin configured as an input (tri-stated)
0 = GPIO pin configured as an output
bit 3
TRISIO<3>: GPIO Tri-State Control bit
Input only
bit 2:0
TRISIO<2:0>: GPIO Tri-State Control bit
1 = GPIO pin configured as an input (tri-stated)
0 = GPIO pin configured as an output
Note 1:
2:
3:
4.2
x = Bit is unknown
TRISIO<3> always reads ‘1’.
TRISIO<5:4> always reads ‘1’ in XT, HS and LP OSC modes.
TRISIO<5> always reads ‘1’ in RC and RCIO and EC modes.
Additional Pin Functions
4.2.3
INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE
Every GPIO pin on the PIC12F683 has an
interrupt-on-change option and a weak pull-up option.
GP0 has an Ultra Low-Power Wake-up option. The
next three sections describe these functions.
Each of the GPIO pins is individually configurable as an
interrupt-on-change pin. Control bits IOCx enable or
disable the interrupt function for each pin. Refer to
Register 4-5. The interrupt-on-change is disabled on a
Power-on Reset.
4.2.1
For enabled interrupt-on-change pins, the values are
compared with the old value latched on the last read of
GPIO. The ‘mismatch’ outputs of the last read are OR’d
together to set the GPIO Change Interrupt Flag bit
(GPIF) in the INTCON register (Register 2-3).
ANSEL REGISTER
The ANSEL register is used to configure the Input
mode of an I/O pin to analog. Setting the appropriate
ANSEL bit high will cause all digital reads on the pin to
be read as ‘0’ and allow analog functions on the pin to
operate correctly.
The state of the ANSEL bits has no affect on digital
output functions. A pin with TRIS clear and ANSEL set
will still operate as a digital output, but the Input mode
will be analog. This can cause unexpected behavior
when executing read-modify-write instructions on the
affected port.
4.2.2
WEAK PULL-UPS
Each of the GPIO pins, except GP3, has an individually
configurable internal weak pull-up. Control bits WPUx
enable or disable each pull-up. Refer to Register 4-4.
Each weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the
port pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are
disabled on a Power-on Reset by the GPPU bit of the
OPTION register). A weak pull-up is automatically
enabled for GP3 when configured as MCLR and
disabled when GP3 is an I/O. There is no software
control of the MCLR pull-up.
DS41211D-page 32
This interrupt can wake the device from Sleep. The
user, in the Interrupt Service Routine, clears the
interrupt by:
a)
b)
Any read or write of GPIO. This will end the
mismatch condition, then,
Clear the flag bit GPIF.
A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit GPIF.
Reading GPIO will end the mismatch condition and
allow flag bit GPIF to be cleared. The latch holding the
last read value is not affected by a MCLR nor
Brown-out Reset. After these resets, the GPIF flag will
continue to be set if a mismatch is present.
Note:
If a change on the I/O pin should occur
when any GPIO operation is being
executed, then the GPIF interrupt flag may
not get set.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
REGISTER 4-3:
ANSEL: ANALOG SELECT REGISTER
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
—
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
ANS3
ANS2
ANS1
ANS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-4
ADCS<2:0>: A/D Conversion Clock Select bits
000 = FOSC/2
001 = FOSC/8
010 = FOSC/32
x11 = FRC (clock derived from a dedicated internal oscillator = 500 kHz max)
100 = FOSC/4
101 = FOSC/16
110 = FOSC/64
bit 3-0
ANS<3:0>: Analog Select bits
Analog select between analog or digital function on pins AN<3:0>, respectively.
1 = Analog input. Pin is assigned as analog input(1).
0 = Digital I/O. Pin is assigned to port or special function.
Note 1:
x = Bit is unknown
Setting a pin to an analog input automatically disables the digital input circuitry, weak pull-ups and interrupt-on-change,
if available. The corresponding TRIS bit must be set to Input mode in order to allow external control of the voltage on
the pin.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 33
PIC12F683
REGISTER 4-4:
WPU: WEAK PULL-UP REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
—
—
WPU5
WPU4
—
WPU2
WPU1
WPU0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
WPU<5:4>: Weak Pull-up Control bits
1 = Pull-up enabled
0 = Pull-up disabled
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
WPU<2:0>: Weak Pull-up Control bits
1 = Pull-up enabled
0 = Pull-up disabled
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
x = Bit is unknown
Global GPPU must be enabled for individual pull-ups to be enabled.
The weak pull-up device is automatically disabled if the pin is in Output mode (TRISIO = 0).
The GP3 pull-up is enabled when configured as MCLR and disabled as an I/O in the Configuration Word.
WPU<5:4> always reads ‘1’ in XT, HS and LP OSC modes.
REGISTER 4-5:
IOC: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE GPIO REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
IOC5
IOC4
IOC3
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-0
IOC<5:0>: Interrupt-on-change GPIO Control bits
1 = Interrupt-on-change enabled
0 = Interrupt-on-change disabled
Note 1:
2:
x = Bit is unknown
Global Interrupt Enable (GIE) must be enabled for individual interrupts to be recognized.
IOC<5:4> always reads ‘0’ in XT, HS and LP OSC modes.
DS41211D-page 34
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
4.2.4
ULTRA LOW-POWER WAKE-UP
The Ultra Low-Power Wake-up (ULPWU) on GP0
allows a slow falling voltage to generate an interrupt-on-change on GP0 without excess current consumption. The mode is selected by setting the
ULPWUE bit of the PCON register. This enables a
small current sink which can be used to discharge a
capacitor on GP0.
To use this feature, the GP0 pin is configured to output
‘1’ to charge the capacitor, interrupt-on-change for GP0
is enabled and GP0 is configured as an input. The ULPWUE bit is set to begin the discharge and a SLEEP
instruction is performed. When the voltage on GP0
drops below VIL, an interrupt will be generated which will
cause the device to wake-up. Depending on the state of
the GIE bit of the INTCON register, the device will either
jump to the interrupt vector (0004h) or execute the next
instruction when the interrupt event occurs. See
Section 4.2.3
“Interrupt-on-Change”
and
Section 12.4.3 “GPIO Interrupt” for more information.
This feature provides a low-power technique for periodically waking up the device from Sleep. The time-out is
dependent on the discharge time of the RC circuit
on GP0. See Example 4-2 for initializing the Ultra
Low-Power Wake-up module.
Note:
For more information, refer to the Application Note AN879, “Using the Microchip
Ultra Low-Power Wake-up Module”
(DS00879).
EXAMPLE 4-2:
BANKSEL
MOVLW
MOVWF
BANKSEL
BCF
BCF
BANKSEL
BSF
CALL
BANKSEL
BSF
BSF
BSF
MOVLW
MOVWF
SLEEP
NOP
ULTRA LOW-POWER
WAKE-UP INITIALIZATION
CMCON0
H’7’
CMCON0
ANSEL
ANSEL,0
TRISA,0
PORTA
PORTA,0
CapDelay
PCON
PCON,ULPWUE
IOCA,0
TRISA,0
B’10001000’
INTCON
;
;Turn off
;comparators
;
;RA0 to digital I/O
;Output high to
;
;charge capacitor
;
;
;Enable ULP Wake-up
;Select RA0 IOC
;RA0 to input
;Enable interrupt
; and clear flag
;Wait for IOC
;
The series resistor provides overcurrent protection for
the GP0 pin and can allow for software calibration of the
time-out (see Figure 4-1). A timer can be used to measure the charge time and discharge time of the capacitor. The charge time can then be adjusted to provide the
desired interrupt delay. This technique will compensate
for the affects of temperature, voltage and component
accuracy. The Ultra Low-Power Wake-up peripheral
can also be configured as a simple Programmable
Low-Voltage Detect or temperature sensor.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 35
PIC12F683
4.2.5
PIN DESCRIPTIONS AND
DIAGRAMS
4.2.5.1
Figure 4-1 shows the diagram for this pin. The GP0 pin
is configurable to function as one of the following:
Each GPIO pin is multiplexed with other functions. The
pins and their combined functions are briefly described
here. For specific information about individual functions
such as the comparator or the ADC, refer to the
appropriate section in this data sheet.
FIGURE 4-1:
GP0/AN0/CIN+/ICSPDAT/ULPWU
•
•
•
•
•
a general purpose I/O
an analog input for the ADC
an analog input to the comparator
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ data
an analog input to the Ultra Low-Power Wake-up
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF GP0
Analog
Input Mode(1)
VDD
Data Bus
WR
WPU
D
Q
Weak
CK Q
GPPU
RD
WPU
VDD
D
WR
GPIO
Q
I/O pin
CK Q
VSS
+
D
WR
TRISIO
VT
Q
CK Q
IULP
0
RD
TRISIO
1
Analog
Input Mode(1)
VSS
ULPWUE
RD
GPIO
D
WR
IOC
Q
CK Q
Q
D
EN
RD
IOC
Q
Q3
D
EN
Interrupt-onChange
RD GPIO
To Comparator
To A/D Converter
Note
DS41211D-page 36
1:
Comparator mode and ANSEL determines Analog Input mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
4.2.5.2
GP1/AN1/CIN-/VREF/ICSPCLK
4.2.5.3
GP2/AN2/T0CKI/INT/COUT/CCP1
Figure 4-2 shows the diagram for this pin. The GP1 pin
is configurable to function as one of the following:
Figure 4-3 shows the diagram for this pin. The GP2 pin
is configurable to function as one of the following:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
a general purpose I/O
an analog input for the ADC
a analog input to the comparator
a voltage reference input for the ADC
In-Circuit Serial Programming clock
FIGURE 4-2:
Data
Bus
WR
WPU
D
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF GP1
Q
Analog
Input Mode(1)
Weak
Data
Bus
GPPU
RD
WPU
D
WR
GPIO
FIGURE 4-3:
VDD
CK Q
a general purpose I/O
an analog input for the ADC
the clock input for Timer0
an external edge triggered interrupt
a digital output from the Comparator
a digital input/output for the CCP (refer to
Section 11.0 “Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP)
Module”).
D
WR
WPU
Q
CK
Analog
Input Mode
VDD
Q
Weak
GPPU
RD
WPU
VDD
Q
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF GP2
Analog
Input
Mode
COUT
Enable
CK Q
D
VDD
Q
I/O pin
D
WR
TRISIO
WR
GPIO
Q
CK Q
RD
GPIO
Q
CK Q
D
EN
RD
IOC
Q
1
I/O pin
Q
CK
Q
VSS
Analog
Input Mode
RD
TRISIO
Q
COUT
0
D
WR
TRISIO
D
Q
VSS
Analog
Input Mode(1)
RD
TRISIO
WR
IOC
CK
RD
GPIO
Q3
D
D
WR
IOC
Q
CK
Q
EN
EN
Interrupt-onchange
RD
IOC
Q
RD GPIO
To Comparator
D
Q
Q3
D
EN
Interrupt-onchange
To A/D Converter
RD GPIO
Note 1: Comparator mode and ANSEL determines Analog
Input mode.
To Timer0
To INT
To A/D Converter
Note
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
1:
Comparator mode and ANSEL determines Analog
Input mode.
DS41211D-page 37
PIC12F683
4.2.5.4
GP3/MCLR/VPP
4.2.5.5
GP4/AN3/T1G/OSC2/CLKOUT
Figure 4-4 shows the diagram for this pin. The GP3 pin
is configurable to function as one of the following:
Figure 4-5 shows the diagram for this pin. The GP4 pin
is configurable to function as one of the following:
• a general purpose input
• as Master Clear Reset with weak pull-up
•
•
•
•
•
FIGURE 4-4:
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF GP3
VDD
MCLRE
Data
Bus
MCLRE
Reset
RD
TRISIO
MCLRE
D
CK
VSS
Q
Q
FIGURE 4-5:
Input
pin
VSS
RD
GPIO
WR
IOC
Weak
a general purpose I/O
an analog input for the ADC
a Timer1 gate input
a crystal/resonator connection
a clock output
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF GP4
Analog
Input Mode
Data
Bus
WR
WPU
D
CK
Q
VDD
Q
Weak
GPPU
RD
WPU
D
Oscillator
Circuit
Q
EN
RD
IOC
Interrupt-onchange
Q
CLK(1)
Modes
OSC1
Q3
VDD
CLKOUT
Enable
D
D
EN
WR
GPIO
FOSC/4
Q
1
0
CK Q
I/O pin
CLKOUT
Enable
RD GPIO
VSS
D
WR
TRISIO
Q
INTOSC/
RC/EC(2)
CK Q
CLKOUT
Enable
RD
TRISIO
Analog
Input Mode
RD
GPIO
D
WR
IOC
Q
Q
CK Q
D
EN
RD
IOC
Q
Q3
D
EN
Interrupt-onchange
RD GPIO
To T1G
To A/D Converter
Note 1: CLK modes are XT, HS, LP, optional LP oscillator and
CLKOUT Enable.
2: With CLKOUT option.
DS41211D-page 38
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
4.2.5.6
GP5/T1CKI/OSC1/CLKIN
FIGURE 4-6:
Figure 4-6 shows the diagram for this pin. The GP5 pin
is configurable to function as one of the following:
•
•
•
•
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF GP5
INTOSC
Mode
Data
Bus
a general purpose I/O
a Timer1 clock input
a crystal/resonator connection
a clock input
VDD
Q
D
WR
WPU
TMR1LPEN(1)
CK
Weak
Q
GPPU
RD
WPU
Oscillator
Circuit
OSC2
D
WR
GPIO
VDD
Q
CK
Q
I/O pin
Q
D
WR
TRISIO
CK
Q
VSS
INTOSC
Mode
RD
TRISIO
(1)
RD
GPIO
D
Q
CK
WR
IOC
Q
D
Q
EN
Q3
RD
IOC
Q
D
EN
Interrupt-onchange
RD GPIO
To Timer1 or CLKGEN
Note
1: Timer1 LP oscillator enabled.
2: When using Timer1 with LP oscillator, the
Schmitt Trigger is bypassed.
TABLE 4-1:
Name
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH GPIO
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Value on
all other
Resets
ANSEL
—
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
ANS3
ANS2
ANS1
ANS0
-000 1111
-000 1111
CCP1CON
—
—
DC1B1
DC1B0
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1
CCP1M0
--00 0000
--00 0000
CMCON0
—
COUT
—
CINV
CIS
CM2
CM1
CM0
-0-0 0000
-0-0 0000
PCON
—
—
ULPWUE
SBOREN
—
—
POR
BOR
--01 --qq
--0u --uu
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000
0000 000x
—
—
IOC5
IOC4
IOC3
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
--00 0000
--00 0000
GPPU
INTEDG
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
1111 1111
1111 1111
—
—
GP5
GP4
GP3
GP2
GP1
GP0
--xx xxxx
--x0 x000
0000 0000
INTCON
IOC
OPTION_REG
GPIO
T1CON
T1GINV
TMR1GE
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN
T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
0000 0000
TRISIO
—
—
TRISIO5
TRISIO4
TRISIO3
TRISIO2
TRISIO1
TRISIO0
--11 1111
--11 1111
WPU
—
—
WPU5
WPU4
—
WPU2
WPU1
WPU0
--11 -111
--11 -111
Legend:
x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by GPIO.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 39
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 40
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
5.0
TIMER0 MODULE
5.1
Timer0 Operation
The Timer0 module is an 8-bit timer/counter with the
following features:
When used as a timer, the Timer0 module can be used
as either an 8-bit timer or an 8-bit counter.
•
•
•
•
•
5.1.1
8-bit timer/counter register (TMR0)
8-bit prescaler (shared with Watchdog Timer)
Programmable internal or external clock source
Programmable external clock edge selection
Interrupt on overflow
8-BIT TIMER MODE
When used as a timer, the Timer0 module will
increment every instruction cycle (without prescaler).
Timer mode is selected by clearing the T0CS bit of the
OPTION register to ‘0’.
Figure 5-1 is a block diagram of the Timer0 module.
When TMR0 is written, the increment is inhibited for
two instruction cycles immediately following the write.
Note:
5.1.2
The value written to the TMR0 register can
be adjusted, in order to account for the two
instruction cycle delay when TMR0 is
written.
8-BIT COUNTER MODE
When used as a counter, the Timer0 module will
increment on every rising or falling edge of the T0CKI
pin. The incrementing edge is determined by the T0SE
bit of the OPTION register. Counter mode is selected by
setting the T0CS bit of the OPTION register to ‘1’.
FIGURE 5-1:
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF THE TIMER0/WDT PRESCALER
FOSC/4
Data Bus
0
8
1
Sync
2 Tcy
1
T0CKI
pin
TMR0
0
0
T0SE
T0CS
Set Flag bit T0IF
on Overflow
8-bit
Prescaler
PSA
1
8
PSA
WDTE
SWDTEN
PS<2:0>
16-bit
Prescaler
31 kHz
INTOSC
1
WDT
Time-out
0
16
Watchdog
Timer
PSA
WDTPS<3:0>
Note
1:
T0SE, T0CS, PSA, PS<2:0> are bits in the OPTION register.
2:
SWDTEN and WDTPS<3:0> are bits in the WDTCON register.
3:
WDTE bit is in the Configuration Word register.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 41
PIC12F683
5.1.3
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMABLE
PRESCALER
A single software programmable prescaler is available
for use with either Timer0 or the Watchdog Timer
(WDT), but not both simultaneously. The prescaler
assignment is controlled by the PSA bit of the OPTION
register. To assign the prescaler to Timer0, the PSA bit
must be cleared to a ‘0’.
There are 8 prescaler options for the Timer0 module
ranging from 1:2 to 1:256. The prescale values are
selectable via the PS<2:0> bits of the OPTION register.
In order to have a 1:1 prescaler value for the Timer0
module, the prescaler must be assigned to the WDT
module.
The prescaler is not readable or writable. When
assigned to the Timer0 module, all instructions writing to
the TMR0 register will clear the prescaler.
When the prescaler is assigned to WDT, a CLRWDT
instruction will clear the prescaler along with the WDT.
5.1.3.1
Switching Prescaler Between
Timer0 and WDT Modules
As a result of having the prescaler assigned to either
Timer0 or the WDT, it is possible to generate an
unintended device Reset when switching prescaler
values. When changing the prescaler assignment from
Timer0 to the WDT module, the instruction sequence
shown in Example 5-1, must be executed.
EXAMPLE 5-1:
BANKSEL
CLRWDT
CLRF
CHANGING PRESCALER
(TIMER0 → WDT)
TMR0
TMR0
BANKSEL
BSF
CLRWDT
OPTION_REG
OPTION_REG,PSA
MOVLW
ANDWF
IORLW
MOVWF
b’11111000’
OPTION_REG,W
b’00000101’
OPTION_REG
DS41211D-page 42
;
;Clear WDT
;Clear TMR0 and
;prescaler
;
;Select WDT
;
;
;Mask prescaler
;bits
;Set WDT prescaler
;to 1:32
When changing the prescaler assignment from the
WDT to the Timer0 module, the following instruction
sequence must be executed (see Example 5-2).
EXAMPLE 5-2:
CHANGING PRESCALER
(WDT → TIMER0)
CLRWDT
;Clear WDT and
;prescaler
BANKSEL OPTION_REG
;
MOVLW
b’11110000’ ;Mask TMR0 select and
ANDWF
OPTION_REG,W ;prescaler bits
IORLW
b’00000011’ ;Set prescale to 1:16
MOVWF
OPTION_REG
;
5.1.4
TIMER0 INTERRUPT
Timer0 will generate an interrupt when the TMR0
register overflows from FFh to 00h. The T0IF interrupt
flag bit of the INTCON register is set every time the
TMR0 register overflows, regardless of whether or not
the Timer0 interrupt is enabled. The T0IF bit must be
cleared in software. The Timer0 interrupt enable is the
T0IE bit of the INTCON register.
Note:
5.1.5
The Timer0 interrupt cannot wake the
processor from Sleep since the timer is
frozen during Sleep.
USING TIMER0 WITH AN
EXTERNAL CLOCK
When Timer0 is in Counter mode, the synchronization
of the T0CKI input and the Timer0 register is accomplished by sampling the prescaler output on the Q2 and
Q4 cycles of the internal phase clocks. Therefore, the
high and low periods of the external clock source must
meet the timing requirements as shown in the
Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications”.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
REGISTER 5-1:
OPTION_REG: OPTION REGISTER
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
GPPU
INTEDG
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
GPPU: GPIO Pull-up Enable bit
1 = GPIO pull-ups are disabled
0 = GPIO pull-ups are enabled by individual PORT latch values in WPU register
bit 6
INTEDG: Interrupt Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge of INT pin
0 = Interrupt on falling edge of INT pin
bit 5
T0CS: Timer0 Clock Source Select bit
1 = Transition on T0CKI pin
0 = Internal instruction cycle clock (FOSC/4)
bit 4
T0SE: Timer0 Source Edge Select bit
1 = Increment on high-to-low transition on T0CKI pin
0 = Increment on low-to-high transition on T0CKI pin
bit 3
PSA: Prescaler Assignment bit
1 = Prescaler is assigned to the WDT
0 = Prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module
bit 2-0
PS<2:0>: Prescaler Rate Select bits
BIT VALUE
TIMER0 RATE WDT RATE
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
Note 1:
Name
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER0
Bit 7
TMR0
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Timer0 Module Register
INTCON
OPTION_REG
TRISIO
1:1
1:2
1:4
1:8
1 : 16
1 : 32
1 : 64
1 : 128
A dedicated 16-bit WDT postscaler is available. See Section 12.6 “Watchdog Timer (WDT)” for more
information.
TABLE 5-1:
Legend:
1:2
1:4
1:8
1 : 16
1 : 32
1 : 64
1 : 128
1 : 256
Value on
all other
Resets
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000
0000 000x
GPPU
INTEDG
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
1111 1111
1111 1111
—
—
--11 1111
--11 1111
TRISIO5 TRISIO4 TRISIO3 TRISIO2 TRISIO1 TRISIO0
– = Unimplemented locations, read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer0
module.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 43
PIC12F683
6.0
TIMER1 MODULE WITH GATE
CONTROL
6.1
The Timer1 module is a 16-bit incrementing counter
which is accessed through the TMR1H:TMR1L register
pair. Writes to TMR1H or TMR1L directly update the
counter.
The Timer1 module is a 16-bit timer/counter with the
following features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Timer1 Operation
16-bit timer/counter register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L)
Programmable internal or external clock source
3-bit prescaler
Optional LP oscillator
Synchronous or asynchronous operation
Timer1 gate (count enable) via comparator or
T1G pin
Interrupt on overflow
Wake-up on overflow (external clock,
Asynchronous mode only)
Special Event Trigger (with CCP)
Comparator output synchronization to Timer1
clock
When used with an internal clock source, the module is
a timer. When used with an external clock source, the
module can be used as either a timer or counter.
6.2
Clock Source Selection
The TMR1CS bit of the T1CON register is used to select
the clock source. When TMR1CS = 0, the clock source
is FOSC/4. When TMR1CS = 1, the clock source is
supplied externally.
Clock Source
TMR1CS
FOSC/4
0
T1CKI pin
1
Figure 6-1 is a block diagram of the Timer1 module.
FIGURE 6-1:
TIMER1 BLOCK DIAGRAM
TMR1GE
T1GINV
TMR1ON
Set flag bit
TMR1IF on
Overflow
To Comparator Module
Timer1 Clock
TMR1(2)
TMR1H
TMR1L
Synchronized
clock input
0
EN
1
Oscillator
(1)
T1SYNC
OSC1/T1CKI
OSC2/T1G
1
FOSC/4
Internal
Clock
Synchronize(3)
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
det
0
2
T1CKPS<1:0>
TMR1CS
1
INTOSC
Without CLKOUT
T1OSCEN
COUT
0
T1GSS
Note 1:
2:
3:
DS41211D-page 44
ST Buffer is low power type when using LP oscillator, or high speed type when using T1CKI.
Timer1 register increments on rising edge.
Synchronize does not operate while in Sleep.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
6.2.1
INTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE
When the internal clock source is selected the
TMR1H:TMR1L register pair will increment on multiples
of TCY as determined by the Timer1 prescaler.
6.2.2
EXTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE
When the external clock source is selected, the Timer1
module may work as a timer or a counter.
When counting, Timer1 is incremented on the rising
edge of the external clock input T1CKI. In addition, the
Counter mode clock can be synchronized to the
microcontroller system clock or run asynchronously.
6.5
If control bit T1SYNC of the T1CON register is set, the
external clock input is not synchronized. The timer
continues to increment asynchronous to the internal
phase clocks. The timer will continue to run during
Sleep and can generate an interrupt on overflow,
which will wake-up the processor. However, special
precautions in software are needed to read/write the
timer (see Section 6.5.1 “Reading and Writing
Timer1 in Asynchronous Counter Mode”).
Note:
If an external clock oscillator is needed (and the
microcontroller is using the INTOSC without CLKOUT),
Timer1 can use the LP oscillator as a clock source.
Note:
6.3
In Counter mode, a falling edge must be
registered by the counter prior to the first
incrementing rising edge.
6.4
Timer1 Oscillator
A low-power 32.768 kHz crystal oscillator is built-in
between pins OSC1 (input) and OSC2 (amplifier
output). The oscillator is enabled by setting the
T1OSCEN control bit of the T1CON register. The
oscillator will continue to run during Sleep.
The Timer1 oscillator is shared with the system LP
oscillator. Thus, Timer1 can use this mode only when
the primary system clock is derived from the internal
oscillator or when in LP oscillator mode. The user must
provide a software time delay to ensure proper oscillator start-up.
TRISIO<5:4> bits are set when the Timer1 oscillator is
enabled. GP5 and GP4 bits read as ‘0’ and TRISIO5
and TRISIO4 bits read as ‘1’.
Note:
6.5.1
Timer1 Prescaler
Timer1 has four prescaler options allowing 1, 2, 4 or 8
divisions of the clock input. The T1CKPS bits of the
T1CON register control the prescale counter. The
prescale counter is not directly readable or writable;
however, the prescaler counter is cleared upon a write to
TMR1H or TMR1L.
The oscillator requires a start-up and
stabilization time before use. Thus,
T1OSCEN should be set and a suitable
delay observed prior to enabling Timer1.
Timer1 Operation in
Asynchronous Counter Mode
When switching from synchronous to
asynchronous operation, it is possible to
skip an increment. When switching from
asynchronous to synchronous operation,
it is possible to produce a single spurious
increment.
READING AND WRITING TIMER1 IN
ASYNCHRONOUS COUNTER
MODE
Reading TMR1H or TMR1L while the timer is running
from an external asynchronous clock will ensure a valid
read (taken care of in hardware). However, the user
should keep in mind that reading the 16-bit timer in two
8-bit values itself, poses certain problems, since the
timer may overflow between the reads.
For writes, it is recommended that the user simply stop
the timer and write the desired values. A write
contention may occur by writing to the timer registers,
while the register is incrementing. This may produce an
unpredictable value in the TMR1H:TTMR1L register
pair.
6.6
Timer1 Gate
Timer1 gate source is software configurable to be the
T1G pin or the output of the Comparator. This allows the
device to directly time external events using T1G or
analog events using Comparator 2. See the CMCON1
register (Register 8-2) for selecting the Timer1 gate
source. This feature can simplify the software for a
Delta-Sigma A/D converter and many other applications.
For more information on Delta-Sigma A/D converters,
see the Microchip web site (www.microchip.com).
Note:
TMR1GE bit of the T1CON register must
be set to use either T1G or COUT as the
Timer1 gate source. See Register 8-2 for
more information on selecting the Timer1
gate source.
Timer1 gate can be inverted using the T1GINV bit of
the T1CON register, whether it originates from the T1G
pin or Comparator 2 output. This configures Timer1 to
measure either the active-high or active-low time
between events.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 45
PIC12F683
6.7
Timer1 Interrupt
6.9
CCP Special Event Trigger
The Timer1 register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) increments
to FFFFh and rolls over to 0000h. When Timer1 rolls
over, the Timer1 interrupt flag bit of the PIR1 register is
set. To enable the interrupt on rollover, you must set
these bits:
If a CCP is configured to trigger a special event, the
trigger will clear the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. This
special event does not cause a Timer1 interrupt. The
CCP module may still be configured to generate a CCP
interrupt.
• Timer1 interrupt enable bit of the PIE1 register
• PEIE bit of the INTCON register
• GIE bit of the INTCON register
In this mode of operation, the CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair effectively becomes the period register for
Timer1.
The interrupt is cleared by clearing the TMR1IF bit in
the Interrupt Service Routine.
Timer1 should be synchronized to the FOSC to utilize
the Special Event Trigger. Asynchronous operation of
Timer1 can cause a Special Event Trigger to be
missed.
Note:
6.8
The TMR1H:TTMR1L register pair and the
TMR1IF bit should be cleared before
enabling interrupts.
Timer1 Operation During Sleep
In the event that a write to TMR1H or TMR1L coincides
with a Special Event Trigger from the CCP, the write will
take precedence.
For more information, see Section on CCP.
Timer1 can only operate during Sleep when setup in
Asynchronous Counter mode. In this mode, an external
crystal or clock source can be used to increment the
counter. To set up the timer to wake the device:
• TMR1ON bit of the T1CON register must be set
• TMR1IE bit of the PIE1 register must be set
• PEIE bit of the INTCON register must be set
The device will wake-up on an overflow and execute
the next instruction. If the GIE bit of the INTCON
register is set, the device will call the Interrupt Service
Routine (0004h).
FIGURE 6-2:
6.10
Comparator Synchronization
The same clock used to increment Timer1 can also be
used to synchronize the comparator output. This
feature is enabled in the Comparator module.
When using the comparator for Timer1 gate, the
comparator output should be synchronized to Timer1.
This ensures Timer1 does not miss an increment if the
comparator changes.
For more information, see Section 8.0 “Comparator
Module”.
TIMER1 INCREMENTING EDGE
T1CKI = 1
when TMR1
Enabled
T1CKI = 0
when TMR1
Enabled
Note 1:
2:
Arrows indicate counter increments.
In Counter mode, a falling edge must be registered by the counter prior to the first incrementing rising edge of
the clock.
DS41211D-page 46
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
6.11
Timer1 Control Register
The Timer1 Control register (T1CON), shown in
Register 6-1, is used to control Timer1 and select the
various features of the Timer1 module.
REGISTER 6-1:
R/W-0
R/W-0
(1)
T1GINV
T1CON: TIMER1 CONTROL REGISTER
(2)
TMR1GE
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
T1CKPS1
T1CKPS0
T1OSCEN
T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
T1GINV: Timer1 Gate Invert bit(1)
1 = Timer1 gate is active-high (Timer1 counts when gate is high)
0 = Timer1 gate is active-low (Timer1 counts when gate is low)
bit 6
TMR1GE: Timer1 Gate Enable bit(2)
If TMR1ON = 0:
This bit is ignored
If TMR1ON = 1:
1 = Timer1 is on if Timer1 gate is not active
0 = Timer1 is on
bit 5-4
T1CKPS<1:0>: Timer1 Input Clock Prescale Select bits
11 = 1:8 Prescale Value
10 = 1:4 Prescale Value
01 = 1:2 Prescale Value
00 = 1:1 Prescale Value
bit 3
T1OSCEN: LP Oscillator Enable Control bit
If INTOSC without CLKOUT oscillator is active:
1 = LP oscillator is enabled for Timer1 clock
0 = LP oscillator is off
Else:
This bit is ignored. LP oscillator is disabled.
bit 2
T1SYNC: Timer1 External Clock Input Synchronization Control bit
TMR1CS = 1:
1 = Do not synchronize external clock input
0 = Synchronize external clock input
TMR1CS = 0:
This bit is ignored. Timer1 uses the internal clock
bit 1
TMR1CS: Timer1 Clock Source Select bit
1 = External clock from T1CKI pin (on the rising edge)
0 = Internal clock (FOSC/4)
bit 0
TMR1ON: Timer1 On bit
1 = Enables Timer1
0 = Stops Timer1
Note 1:
2:
x = Bit is unknown
T1GINV bit inverts the Timer1 gate logic, regardless of source.
TMR1GE bit must be set to use either T1G pin or COUT, as selected by the T1GSS bit of the CMCON1
register, as a Timer1 gate source.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 47
PIC12F683
TABLE 6-1:
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER1
Value on
all other
Resets
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
CONFIG(1)
CPD
CP
MCLRE
PWRTE
WDTE
FOSC2
FOSC1
FOSC0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
T1GSS
CMSYNC
---- --10
---- --10
0000 000x
CMCON1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Name
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000
PIE1
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
000- 0000
000- 0000
PIR1
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
000- 0000
000- 0000
TMR1H
Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
TMR1L
Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
T1CON
Legend:
Note 1:
T1GINV
TMR1GE
T1CKPS1
T1CKPS0
T1OSCEN
T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer1 module.
See Configuration Word register (Register 12-1) for operation of all register bits.
DS41211D-page 48
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
7.0
TIMER2 MODULE
The Timer2 module is an 8-bit timer with the following
features:
•
•
•
•
•
8-bit timer register (TMR2)
8-bit period register (PR2)
Interrupt on TMR2 match with PR2
Software programmable prescaler (1:1, 1:4, 1:16)
Software programmable postscaler (1:1 to 1:16)
Timer2 is turned on by setting the TMR2ON bit in the
T2CON register to a ‘1’. Timer2 is turned off by clearing
the TMR2ON bit to a ‘0’.
The Timer2 prescaler is controlled by the T2CKPS bits
in the T2CON register. The Timer2 postscaler is
controlled by the TOUTPS bits in the T2CON register.
The prescaler and postscaler counters are cleared
when:
See Figure 7-1 for a block diagram of Timer2.
7.1
The TMR2 and PR2 registers are both fully readable
and writable. On any Reset, the TMR2 register is set to
00h and the PR2 register is set to FFh.
Timer2 Operation
The clock input to the Timer2 module is the system
instruction clock (FOSC/4). The clock is fed into the
Timer2 prescaler, which has prescale options of 1:1,
1:4 or 1:16. The output of the prescaler is then used to
increment the TMR2 register.
• A write to TMR2 occurs.
• A write to T2CON occurs.
• Any device Reset occurs (Power-on Reset, MCLR
Reset, Watchdog Timer Reset, or Brown-out
Reset).
Note:
The values of TMR2 and PR2 are constantly compared
to determine when they match. TMR2 will increment
from 00h until it matches the value in PR2. When a
match occurs, two things happen:
TMR2 is not cleared when T2CON is
written.
• TMR2 is reset to 00h on the next increment cycle.
• The Timer2 postscaler is incremented
The match output of the Timer2/PR2 comparator is
then fed into the Timer2 postscaler. The postscaler has
postscale options of 1:1 to 1:16 inclusive. The output of
the Timer2 postscaler is used to set the TMR2IF
interrupt flag bit in the PIR1 register.
FIGURE 7-1:
TIMER2 BLOCK DIAGRAM
TMR2
Output
FOSC/4
Prescaler
1:1, 1:4, 1:16
2
TMR2
Sets Flag
bit TMR2IF
Reset
Comparator
EQ
Postscaler
1:1 to 1:16
T2CKPS<1:0>
PR2
4
TOUTPS<3:0>
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 49
PIC12F683
REGISTER 7-1:
T2CON: TIMER 2 CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
TOUTPS3
TOUTPS2
TOUTPS1
TOUTPS0
TMR2ON
T2CKPS1
T2CKPS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-3
TOUTPS<3:0>: Timer2 Output Postscaler Select bits
0000 = 1:1 Postscaler
0001 = 1:2 Postscaler
0010 = 1:3 Postscaler
0011 = 1:4 Postscaler
0100 = 1:5 Postscaler
0101 = 1:6 Postscaler
0110 = 1:7 Postscaler
0111 = 1:8 Postscaler
1000 = 1:9 Postscaler
1001 = 1:10 Postscaler
1010 = 1:11 Postscaler
1011 = 1:12 Postscaler
1100 = 1:13 Postscaler
1101 = 1:14 Postscaler
1110 = 1:15 Postscaler
1111 = 1:16 Postscaler
bit 2
TMR2ON: Timer2 On bit
1 = Timer2 is on
0 = Timer2 is off
bit 1-0
T2CKPS<1:0>: Timer2 Clock Prescale Select bits
00 = Prescaler is 1
01 = Prescaler is 4
1x = Prescaler is 16
TABLE 7-1:
Name
Bit 7
x = Bit is unknown
SUMMARY OF ASSOCIATED TIMER2 REGISTERS
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Value on
all other
Resets
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000
0000 000x
PIE1
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
000- 0000
000- 0000
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
PIR1
000- 0000
000- 0000
PR2
Timer2 Module Period Register
1111 1111
1111 1111
TMR2
Holding Register for the 8-bit TMR2 Register
0000 0000
0000 0000
-000 0000
-000 0000
T2CON
—
Legend:
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for Timer2 module.
DS41211D-page 50
TOUTPS3
TOUTPS2
TOUTPS1
TOUTPS0
TMR2ON
T2CKPS1
T2CKPS0
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
8.0
COMPARATOR MODULE
FIGURE 8-1:
Comparators are used to interface analog circuits to a
digital circuit by comparing two analog voltages and
providing a digital indication of their relative magnitudes.
The comparators are very useful mixed signal building
blocks because they provide analog functionality
independent of the program execution. The analog
comparator module includes the following features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
VIN+
+
VIN-
–
Output
VINVIN+
Multiple comparator configurations
Comparator output is available internally/externally
Programmable output polarity
Interrupt-on-change
Wake-up from Sleep
Timer1 gate (count enable)
Output synchronization to Timer1 clock input
Programmable voltage reference
8.1
SINGLE COMPARATOR
Output
Note:
The black areas of the output of the
comparator represents the uncertainty
due to input offsets and response time.
Comparator Overview
The comparator is shown in Figure 8-1 along with the
relationship between the analog input levels and the
digital output. When the analog voltage at VIN+ is less
than the analog voltage at VIN-, the output of the
comparator is a digital low level. When the analog
voltage at VIN+ is greater than the analog voltage at
VIN-, the output of the comparator is a digital high level.
FIGURE 8-2:
COMPARATOR OUTPUT BLOCK DIAGRAM
CMSYNC
Port Pins
MULTIPLEX
To Timer1 Gate
CINV
0
To COUT pin
D
Q
D
Q
1
Timer1
clock source(1)
Q1
EN
To Data Bus
RD CMCON0
Set CMIF bit
D
Q3*RD CMCON0
Q
EN
CL
Reset
Note 1:
Comparator output is latched on falling edge of Timer1 clock source.
2:
Q1 and Q3 are phases of the four-phase system clock (FOSC).
3:
Q1 is held high during Sleep mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 51
PIC12F683
8.2
Analog Input Connection
Considerations
A simplified circuit for an analog input is shown in
Figure 8-3. Since the analog input pins share their connection with a digital input, they have reverse biased
ESD protection diodes to VDD and VSS. The analog
input, therefore, must be between VSS and VDD. If the
input voltage deviates from this range by more than
0.6V in either direction, one of the diodes is forward
biased and a latch-up may occur.
Note 1: When reading a PORT register, all pins
configured as analog inputs will read as a
‘0’. Pins configured as digital inputs will
convert as an analog input, according to
the input specification.
2: Analog levels on any pin defined as a
digital input, may cause the input buffer to
consume more current than is specified.
A maximum source impedance of 10 kΩ is recommended
for the analog sources. Also, any external component
connected to an analog input pin, such as a capacitor or
a Zener diode, should have very little leakage current to
minimize inaccuracies introduced.
FIGURE 8-3:
ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
VT ≈ 0.6V
Rs < 10K
RIC
To ADC Input
AIN
VA
CPIN
5 pF
VT ≈ 0.6V
ILEAKAGE
±500 nA
Vss
Legend: CPIN
= Input Capacitance
ILEAKAGE = Leakage Current at the pin due to various junctions
RIC
= Interconnect Resistance
= Source Impedance
RS
= Analog Voltage
VA
VT
= Threshold Voltage
DS41211D-page 52
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
8.3
Comparator Configuration
There are eight modes of operation for the comparator.
The CM<2:0> bits of the CMCON0 register are used to
select these modes as shown in Figure 8-4.
• Analog function (A): digital input buffer is disabled
• Digital function (D): comparator digital output,
overrides port function
• Normal port function (I/O): independent of comparator
FIGURE 8-4:
The port pins denoted as “A” will read as a ‘0’
regardless of the state of the I/O pin or the I/O control
TRIS bit. Pins used as analog inputs should also have
the corresponding TRIS bit set to ‘1’ to disable the
digital output driver. Pins denoted as “D” should have
the corresponding TRIS bit set to ‘0’ to enable the
digital output driver.
Note:
Comparator interrupts should be disabled
during a Comparator mode change to
prevent unintended interrupts.
COMPARATOR I/O OPERATING MODES
Comparator Reset (POR Default Value – low power)
Comparator w/o Output and with Internal Reference
CM<2:0> = 000
CM<2:0> = 100
CINCIN+
A
Off
A
(1)
CIN-
A
CIN+
I/O
COUT
COUT (pin) I/O
COUT (pin) I/O
From CVREF Module
Comparator with Output
Multiplexed Input with Internal Reference and Output
CM<2:0> = 001
CM<2:0> = 101
CIN-
A
CIN+
A
COUT
COUT (pin) D
CIN-
A
CIN+
A
CIS = 0
CIS = 1
COUT
COUT (pin) D
From CVREF Module
Comparator without Output
Multiplexed Input with Internal Reference
CM<2:0> = 010
CM<2:0> = 110
CINCIN+
COUT (pin)
A
A
CINCOUT
A
A
CIN+
COUT (pin)
I/O
CIS = 0
CIS = 1
COUT
I/O
From CVREF Module
Comparator with Output and Internal Reference
Comparator Off (Lowest power)
CM<2:0> = 011
CM<2:0> = 111
CIN-
A
CIN+
I/O
COUT
COUT (pin) D
From CVREF Module
Legend: A = Analog Input, ports always reads ‘0’
I/O = Normal port I/O
Note 1:
CIN-
I/O
CIN+
I/O
Off(1)
COUT (pin) I/O
CIS = Comparator Input Switch (CMCON0<3>)
D = Comparator Digital Output
Reads as ‘0’, unless CINV = 1.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 53
PIC12F683
8.4
Comparator Control
8.5
The CMCON0 register (Register 8-1) provides access
to the following comparator features:
•
•
•
•
Mode selection
Output state
Output polarity
Input switch
8.4.1
COMPARATOR OUTPUT STATE
The Comparator state can always be read internally via
the COUT bit of the CMCON0 register. The comparator
state may also be directed to the COUT pin in the
following modes:
Comparator Response Time
The comparator output is indeterminate for a period of
time after the change of an input source or the selection
of a new reference voltage. This period is referred to as
the response time. The response time of the
comparator differs from the settling time of the voltage
reference. Therefore, both of these times must be
considered when determining the total response time
to a comparator input change. See the Comparator and
Voltage Reference Specifications in Section 15.0
“Electrical Specifications” for more details.
• CM<2:0> = 001
• CM<2:0> = 011
• CM<2:0> = 101
When one of the above modes is selected, the associated TRIS bit of the COUT pin must be cleared.
8.4.2
COMPARATOR OUTPUT POLARITY
Inverting the output of the comparator is functionally
equivalent to swapping the comparator inputs. The
polarity of the comparator output can be inverted by
setting the CINV bit of the CMCON0 register. Clearing
CINV results in a non-inverted output. A complete table
showing the output state versus input conditions and
the polarity bit is shown in Table 8-1.
TABLE 8-1:
OUTPUT STATE VS. INPUT
CONDITIONS
Input Conditions
CINV
COUT
VIN- > VIN+
0
0
VIN- < VIN+
0
1
VIN-
> VIN+
1
1
VIN- < VIN+
1
0
Note:
8.4.3
COUT refers to both the register bit and
output pin.
COMPARATOR INPUT SWITCH
The inverting input of the comparator may be switched
between two analog pins in the following modes:
• CM<2:0> = 101
• CM<2:0> = 110
In the above modes, both pins remain in analog mode
regardless of which pin is selected as the input. The
CIS bit of the CMCON0 register controls the comparator
input switch.
DS41211D-page 54
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
8.6
Comparator Interrupt Operation
The comparator interrupt flag is set whenever there is
a change in the output value of the comparator.
Changes are recognized by means of a mismatch circuit which consists of two latches and an exclusive-or
gate (see Figure 8.2). One latch is updated with the
comparator output level when the CMCON0 register is
read. This latch retains the value until the next read of
the CMCON0 register or the occurrence of a Reset.
The other latch of the mismatch circuit is updated on
every Q1 system clock. A mismatch condition will occur
when a comparator output change is clocked through
the second latch on the Q1 clock cycle. The mismatch
condition will persist, holding the CMIF bit of the PIR1
register true, until either the CMCON0 register is read
or the comparator output returns to the previous state.
Note:
A write operation to the CMCON0 register
will also clear the mismatch condition
because all writes include a read
operation at the beginning of the write
cycle.
Software will need to maintain information about the
status of the comparator output to determine the actual
change that has occurred.
The CMIF bit of the PIR1 register, is the comparator
interrupt flag. This bit must be reset in software by
clearing it to ‘0’. Since it is also possible to write a ‘1’ to
this register, a simulated interrupt may be initiated.
The CMIE bit of the PIE1 register and the PEIE and GIE
bits of the INTCON register must all be set to enable
comparator interrupts. If any of these bits are cleared,
the interrupt is not enabled, although the CMIF bit of
the PIR1 register will still be set if an interrupt condition
occurs.
The user, in the Interrupt Service Routine, can clear the
interrupt in the following manner:
a)
b)
Any read or write of CMCON0. This will end the
mismatch condition.
Clear the CMIF interrupt flag.
FIGURE 8-5:
COMPARATOR
INTERRUPT TIMING W/O
CMCON0 READ
Q1
Q3
CIN+
TRT
COUT
Set CMIF (level)
CMIF
reset by software
FIGURE 8-6:
COMPARATOR
INTERRUPT TIMING WITH
CMCON0 READ
Q1
Q3
CIN+
TRT
COUT
Set CMIF (level)
CMIF
cleared by CMCON0 read
reset by software
Note 1: If a change in the CMCON0 register
(COUT) should occur when a read operation is being executed (start of the Q2
cycle), then the CMIF of the PIR1 register
interrupt flag may not get set.
2: When either comparator is first enabled,
bias circuitry in the Comparator module
may cause an invalid output from the
comparator until the bias circuitry is
stable. Allow about 1 μs for bias settling
then clear the mismatch condition and
interrupt flags before enabling comparator
interrupts.
A persistent mismatch condition will preclude clearing
the CMIF interrupt flag. Reading CMCON0 will end the
mismatch condition and allow the CMIF bit to be
cleared.
Note:
If a change in the CMCON0 register
(COUT) should occur when a read
operation is being executed (start of the
Q2 cycle), then the CMIF interrupt flag
may not get set.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 55
PIC12F683
8.7
Operation During Sleep
8.8
The comparator, if enabled before entering Sleep mode,
remains active during Sleep. The additional current
consumed by the comparator is shown separately in
Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications”. If the
comparator is not used to wake the device, power
consumption can be minimized while in Sleep mode by
turning off the comparator. The comparator is turned off
by selecting mode CM<2:0> = 000 or CM<2:0> = 111
of the CMCON0 register.
Effects of a Reset
A device Reset forces the CMCON0 and CMCON1
registers to their Reset states. This forces the Comparator module to be in the Comparator Reset mode
(CM<2:0> = 000). Thus, all comparator inputs are
analog inputs with the comparator disabled to consume
the smallest current possible.
A change to the comparator output can wake-up the
device from Sleep. To enable the comparator to wake
the device from Sleep, the CMIE bit of the PIE1 register
and the PEIE bit of the INTCON register must be set.
The instruction following the Sleep instruction always
executes following a wake from Sleep. If the GIE bit of
the INTCON register is also set, the device will then
execute the Interrupt Service Routine.
REGISTER 8-1:
CMCON0: COMPARATOR CONFIGURATION REGISTER
U-0
R-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
COUT
—
CINV
CIS
CM2
CM1
CM0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6
COUT: Comparator Output bit
When CINV = 0:
1 = VIN+ > VIN0 = VIN+ < VINWhen CINV = 1:
1 = VIN+ < VIN0 = VIN+ > VIN-
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
CINV: Comparator Output Inversion bit
1 = Output inverted
0 = Output not inverted
bit 3
CIS: Comparator Input Switch bit
When CM<2:0> = 110 or 101:
1 = CIN+ connects to VIN0 = CIN- connects to VINWhen CM<2:0> = 0xx or 100 or 111:
CIS has no effect.
bit 2-0
CM<2:0>: Comparator Mode bits (See Figure 8-5)
000 = CIN pins are configured as analog, COUT pin configured as I/O, Comparator output turned off
001 = CIN pins are configured as analog, COUT pin configured as Comparator output
010 = CIN pins are configured as analog, COUT pin configured as I/O, Comparator output available internally
011 = CIN- pin is configured as analog, CIN+ pin is configured as I/O, COUT pin configured as
Comparator output, CVREF is non-inverting input
100 = CIN- pin is configured as analog, CIN+ pin is configured as I/O, COUT pin is configured as I/O, Comparator output
available internally, CVREF is non-inverting input
101 = CIN pins are configured as analog and multiplexed, COUT pin is configured as
Comparator output, CVREF is non-inverting input
110 = CIN pins are configured as analog and multiplexed, COUT pin is configured as I/O,
Comparator output available internally, CVREF is non-inverting input
111 = CIN pins are configured as I/O, COUT pin is configured as I/O, Comparator output disabled, Comparator off.
DS41211D-page 56
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
8.9
Comparator Gating Timer1
8.10
This feature can be used to time the duration or interval
of analog events. Clearing the T1GSS bit of the
CMCON1 register will enable Timer1 to increment
based on the output of the comparator. This requires
that Timer1 is on and gating is enabled. See
Section 6.0 “Timer1 Module with Gate Control” for
details.
It is recommended to synchronize the comparator with
Timer1 by setting the CMSYNC bit when the
comparator is used as the Timer1 gate source. This
ensures Timer1 does not miss an increment if the
comparator changes during an increment.
REGISTER 8-2:
Synchronizing Comparator Output
to Timer1
The comparator output can be synchronized with
Timer1 by setting the CMSYNC bit of the CMCON1
register. When enabled, the comparator output is
latched on the falling edge of the Timer1 clock source.
If a prescaler is used with Timer1, the comparator
output is latched after the prescaling function. To
prevent a race condition, the comparator output is
latched on the falling edge of the Timer1 clock source
and Timer1 increments on the rising edge of its clock
source. See the Comparator Block Diagram (Figure 82) and the Timer1 Block Diagram (Figure 6-1) for more
information.
CMCON1: COMPARATOR CONFIGURATION REGISTER
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-0
—
—
—
—
—
—
T1GSS
CMSYNC
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 1
T1GSS: Timer1 Gate Source Select bit(1)
1 = Timer 1 Gate Source is T1G pin (pin should be configured as digital input)
0 = Timer 1 Gate Source is comparator output
bit 0
CMSYNC: Comparator Output Synchronization bit(2)
1 = Output is synchronized with falling edge of Timer1 clock
0 = Output is asynchronous
Note 1:
2:
Refer to Section 6.6 “Timer1 Gate”.
Refer to Figure 8-2.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 57
PIC12F683
8.11
EQUATION 8-1:
Comparator Voltage Reference
The Comparator Voltage Reference module provides
an internally generated voltage reference for the
comparators. The following features are available:
•
•
•
•
V RR = 1 (low range):
CVREF = (VR<3:0>/24) × V DD
V RR = 0 (high range):
CV REF = (VDD/4) + (VR<3:0> × VDD/32)
Independent from Comparator operation
Two 16-level voltage ranges
Output clamped to VSS
Ratiometric with VDD
The full range of VSS to VDD cannot be realized due to
the construction of the module. See Figure 8-1.
The VRCON register (Register 8-3) controls the
Voltage Reference module shown in Figure 8-7.
8.11.1
CVREF OUTPUT VOLTAGE
INDEPENDENT OPERATION
8.11.3
OUTPUT CLAMPED TO VSS
The CVREF output voltage can be set to Vss with no
power consumption by configuring VRCON as follows:
The comparator voltage reference is independent of
the comparator configuration. Setting the VREN bit of
the VRCON register will enable the voltage reference.
• VREN = 0
• VRR = 1
• VR<3:0> = 0000
8.11.2
This allows the comparator to detect a zero-crossing
while not consuming additional CVREF module current.
OUTPUT VOLTAGE SELECTION
The CVREF voltage reference has 2 ranges with 16
voltage levels in each range. Range selection is
controlled by the VRR bit of the VRCON register. The
16 levels are set with the VR<3:0> bits of the VRCON
register.
The CVREF output voltage is determined by the following
equations:
REGISTER 8-3:
8.11.4
OUTPUT RATIOMETRIC TO VDD
The comparator voltage reference is VDD derived and
therefore, the CVREF output changes with fluctuations in
VDD. The tested absolute accuracy of the Comparator
Voltage Reference can be found in Section 15.0
“Electrical Specifications”.
VRCON: VOLTAGE REFERENCE CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
VREN
—
VRR
—
VR3
VR2
VR1
VR0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7
VREN: CVREF Enable bit
1 = CVREF circuit powered on
0 = CVREF circuit powered down, no IDD drain and CVREF = VSS.
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
VRR: CVREF Range Selection bit
1 = Low range
0 = High range
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
VR<3:0>: CVREF Value Selection 0 ≤ VR<3:0> ≤ 15
When VRR = 1: CVREF = (VR<3:0>/24) * VDD
When VRR = 0: CVREF = VDD/4 + (VR<3:0>/32) * VDD
DS41211D-page 58
x = Bit is unknown
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 8-7:
COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE BLOCK DIAGRAM
16 Stages
8R
R
R
R
R
VDD
VRR
8R
16-1 Analog
MUX
VREN
15
14
CVREF to
Comparator
Input
2
1
0
VR<3:0>(1)
VREN
VR<3:0> = 0000
VRR
Note 1:
TABLE 8-2:
Care should be taken to ensure VREF
remains within the comparator Common
mode input range. See Section 15.0
“Electrical Specifications” for more detail.
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE COMPARATOR AND VOLTAGE
REFERENCE MODULES
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Value on
all other
Resets
ANSEL
—
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
ANS3
ANS2
ANS1
ANS0
-000 1111
-000 1111
CMCON0
—
COUT
—
CINV
CIS
CM2
CM1
CM0
-0-0 0000
-0-0 0000
CMCON1
—
—
—
—
—
—
T1GSS
CMSYNC
---- --10
---- --10
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000
0000 000x
PIE1
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
000- 0000
0000 0000
Name
PIR1
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
000- 0000
000- 0000
GPIO
—
—
GP5
GP4
GP3
GP2
GP1
GP0
--xx xxxx
--uu uuuu
TRISIO
—
—
TRISIO0
--11 1111
--11 1111
VRCON
VREN
—
VR0
0-0- 0000
-0-0 0000
Legend:
TRISIO5 TRISIO4 TRISIO3 TRISIO2 TRISIO1
VRR
—
VR3
VR2
VR1
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for comparator.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 59
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 60
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
9.0
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER (ADC) MODULE
The ADC voltage reference is software selectable to
either VDD or a voltage applied to the external reference
pins.
The Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) allows
conversion of an analog input signal to a 10-bit binary
representation of that signal. This device uses analog
inputs, which are multiplexed into a single sample and
hold circuit. The output of the sample and hold is
connected to the input of the converter. The converter
generates a 10-bit binary result via successive
approximation and stores the conversion result into the
ADC result registers (ADRESL and ADRESH).
FIGURE 9-1:
The ADC can generate an interrupt upon completion of
a conversion. This interrupt can be used to wake-up the
device from Sleep.
Figure 9-1 shows the block diagram of the ADC.
ADC BLOCK DIAGRAM
VDD
VCFG = 0
VREF
VCFG = 1
GP0/AN0
GP1/AN1/VREF
A/D
GP2/AN2
10
GO/DONE
GP4/AN3
ADFM
CHS
0 = Left Justify
1 = Right Justify
ADON
10
ADRESH
9.1
ADC Configuration
9.1.2
ADRESL
CHANNEL SELECTION
When configuring and using the ADC the following
functions must be considered:
The CHS bits of the ADCON0 register determine which
channel is connected to the sample and hold circuit.
•
•
•
•
•
•
When changing channels, a delay is required before
starting the next conversion. Refer to Section 9.2
“ADC Operation” for more information.
GPIO configuration
Channel selection
ADC voltage reference selection
ADC conversion clock source
Interrupt control
Results formatting
9.1.1
GPIO CONFIGURATION
The ADC can be used to convert both analog and digital
signals. When converting analog signals, the I/O pin
should be configured for analog by setting the associated
TRIS and ANSEL bits. See the corresponding GPIO
section for more information.
Note:
Analog voltages on any pin that is defined
as a digital input may cause the input
buffer to conduct excess current.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 61
PIC12F683
ADC VOLTAGE REFERENCE
9.1.3
The time to complete one bit conversion is defined as
TAD. One full 10-bit conversion requires 11 TAD periods
as shown in Figure 9-2.
The VCFG bit of the ADCON0 register provides control
of the positive voltage reference. The positive voltage
reference can be either VDD or an external voltage
source. The negative voltage reference is always
connected to the ground reference.
9.1.4
For correct conversion, the appropriate TAD specification
must be met. See A/D conversion requirements in
Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications” for more
information. Table 9-1 gives examples of appropriate
ADC clock selections.
CONVERSION CLOCK
The source of the conversion clock is software selectable via the ADCS bits of the ANSEL register. There
are seven possible clock options:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Note:
Unless using the FRC, any changes in the
system clock frequency will change the
ADC clock frequency, which may
adversely affect the ADC result.
FOSC/2
FOSC/4
FOSC/8
FOSC/16
FOSC/32
FOSC/64
FRC (dedicated internal oscillator)
TABLE 9-1:
ADC CLOCK PERIOD (TAD) VS. DEVICE OPERATING FREQUENCIES (VDD > 3.0V)
ADC Clock Period (TAD)
ADC Clock Source
Device Frequency (FOSC)
ADCS<2:0>
FOSC/2
20 MHz
000
100
ns(2)
ns(2)
8 MHz
250
ns(2)
500
ns(2)
4 MHz
500
ns(2)
1.0
μs(2)
1 MHz
2.0 μs
4.0 μs
FOSC/4
100
200
FOSC/8
001
400 ns(2)
1.0 μs(2)
2.0 μs
8.0 μs(3)
FOSC/16
101
800 ns(2)
2.0 μs
4.0 μs
16.0 μs(3)
FOSC/32
010
1.6 μs
4.0 μs
FOSC/64
110
3.2 μs
8.0 μs(3)
FRC
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
2-6
x11
μs(1,4)
2-6
μs(3)
32.0 μs(3)
16.0 μs(3)
64.0 μs(3)
μs(1,4)
2-6 μs(1,4)
8.0
μs(1,4)
2-6
Shaded cells are outside of recommended range.
The FRC source has a typical TAD time of 4 μs for VDD > 3.0V.
These values violate the minimum required TAD time.
For faster conversion times, the selection of another clock source is recommended.
When the device frequency is greater than 1 MHz, the FRC clock source is only recommended if the
conversion will be performed during Sleep.
FIGURE 9-2:
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERSION TAD CYCLES
TCY to TAD TAD1 TAD2 TAD3 TAD4 TAD5 TAD6 TAD7 TAD8 TAD9 TAD10 TAD11
b9
b8
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Conversion Starts
Holding Capacitor is Disconnected from Analog Input (typically 100 ns)
Set GO/DONE bit
DS41211D-page 62
ADRESH and ADRESL registers are loaded,
GO bit is cleared,
ADIF bit is set,
Holding capacitor is connected to analog input
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
9.1.5
INTERRUPTS
9.1.6
The ADC module allows for the ability to generate an
interrupt upon completion of an Analog-to-Digital
conversion. The ADC interrupt flag is the ADIF bit in the
PIR1 register. The ADC interrupt enable is the ADIE bit
in the PIE1 register. The ADIF bit must be cleared in
software.
Note:
RESULT FORMATTING
The 10-bit A/D conversion result can be supplied in two
formats, left justified or right justified. The ADFM bit of
the ADCON0 register controls the output format.
Figure 9-3 shows the two output formats.
The ADIF bit is set at the completion of
every conversion, regardless of whether
or not the ADC interrupt is enabled.
This interrupt can be generated while the device is
operating or while in Sleep. If the device is in Sleep, the
interrupt will wake-up the device. Upon waking from
Sleep, the next instruction following the SLEEP
instruction is always executed. If the user is attempting
to wake-up from Sleep and resume in-line code
execution, the global interrupt must be disabled. If the
global interrupt is enabled, execution will switch to the
interrupt service routine.
Please see Section 12.4 “Interrupts” for more
information.
FIGURE 9-3:
10-BIT A/D CONVERSION RESULT FORMAT
ADRESH
(ADFM = 0)
ADRESL
MSB
LSB
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
10-bit A/D Result
(ADFM = 1)
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
MSB
bit 7
LSB
bit 0
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
9.2
9.2.1
ADC Operation
STARTING A CONVERSION
To enable the ADC module, the ADON bit of the
ADCON0 register must be set to a ‘1’. Setting the
GO/DONE bit of the ADCON0 register to a ‘1’ will start
the Analog-to-Digital conversion.
Note:
The GO/DONE bit should not be set in the
same instruction that turns on the ADC.
Refer to Section 9.2.6 “A/D Conversion
Procedure”.
COMPLETION OF A CONVERSION
When the conversion is complete, the ADC module will:
• Clear the GO/DONE bit
• Set the ADIF flag bit
• Update the ADRESH:ADRESL registers with new
conversion result
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
bit 0
10-bit A/D Result
9.2.3
TERMINATING A CONVERSION
If a conversion must be terminated before completion,
the GO/DONE bit can be cleared in software. The
ADRESH:ADRESL registers will not be updated with
the partially complete Analog-to-Digital conversion
sample. Instead, the ADRESH:ADRESL register pair
will retain the value of the previous conversion. Additionally, a 2 TAD delay is required before another acquisition can be initiated. Following this delay, an input
acquisition is automatically started on the selected
channel.
Note:
9.2.2
bit 0
A device Reset forces all registers to their
Reset state. Thus, the ADC module is
turned off and any pending conversion is
terminated.
DS41211D-page 63
PIC12F683
9.2.4
ADC OPERATION DURING SLEEP
The ADC module can operate during Sleep. This
requires the ADC clock source to be set to the FRC
option. When the FRC clock source is selected, the
ADC waits one additional instruction before starting the
conversion. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be
executed, which can reduce system noise during the
conversion. If the ADC interrupt is enabled, the device
will wake-up from Sleep when the conversion
completes. If the ADC interrupt is disabled, the ADC
module is turned off after the conversion completes,
although the ADON bit remains set.
When the ADC clock source is something other than
FRC, a SLEEP instruction causes the present conversion to be aborted and the ADC module is turned off,
although the ADON bit remains set.
9.2.5
SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER
The CCP Special Event Trigger allows periodic ADC
measurements without software intervention. When
this trigger occurs, the GO/DONE bit is set by hardware
and the Timer1 counter resets to zero.
Using the Special Event Trigger does not assure proper
ADC timing. It is the user’s responsibility to ensure that
the ADC timing requirements are met.
See Section 11.0 “Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP)
Module” for more information.
9.2.6
A/D CONVERSION PROCEDURE
This is an example procedure for using the ADC to
perform an Analog-to-Digital conversion:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Configure GPIO Port:
• Disable pin output driver (See TRIS register)
• Configure pin as analog
Configure the ADC module:
• Select ADC conversion clock
• Configure voltage reference
• Select ADC input channel
• Select result format
• Turn on ADC module
Configure ADC interrupt (optional):
• Clear ADC interrupt flag
• Enable ADC interrupt
• Enable peripheral interrupt
• Enable global interrupt(1)
Wait the required acquisition time(2).
Start conversion by setting the GO/DONE bit.
Wait for ADC conversion to complete by one of
the following:
• Polling the GO/DONE bit
• Waiting for the ADC interrupt (interrupts
enabled)
Read ADC Result
DS41211D-page 64
8.
Clear the ADC interrupt flag (required if interrupt
is enabled).
Note 1: The global interrupt can be disabled if the
user is attempting to wake-up from Sleep
and resume in-line code execution.
2: See Section 9.3
Requirements”.
EXAMPLE 9-1:
“A/D
Acquisition
A/D CONVERSION
;This code block configures the ADC
;for polling, Vdd reference, Frc clock
;and GP0 input.
;
;Conversion start & polling for completion
; are included.
;
BANKSEL TRISIO
;
BSF
TRISIO,0
;Set GP0 to input
BANKSEL ANSEL
;
MOVLW
B’01110001’ ;ADC Frc clock,
IORWF
ANSEL
; and GP0 as analog
BANKSEL ADCON0
;
MOVLW
B’10000001’ ;Right justify,
MOVWF
ADCON0
;Vdd Vref, AN0, On
CALL
SampleTime
;Acquisiton delay
BSF
ADCON0,GO
;Start conversion
BTFSC
ADCON0,GO
;Is conversion done?
GOTO
$-1
;No, test again
BANKSEL ADRESH
;
MOVF
ADRESH,W
;Read upper 2 bits
MOVWF
RESULTHI
;Store in GPR space
BANKSEL ADRESL
;
MOVF
ADRESL,W
;Read lower 8 bits
MOVWF
RESULTLO
;Store in GPR space
9.2.7
ADC REGISTER DEFINITIONS
The following registers are used to control the
operation of the ADC.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
REGISTER 9-1:
ADCON0: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ADFM
VCFG
—
—
CHS1
CHS0
GO/DONE
ADON
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
ADFM: A/D Conversion Result Format Select bit
1 = Right justified
0 = Left justified
bit 6
VCFG: Voltage Reference bit
1 = VREF pin
0 = VDD
bit 5-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-2
CHS<1:0>: Analog Channel Select bits
00 = AN0
01 = AN1
10 = AN2
11 = AN3
bit 1
GO/DONE: A/D Conversion Status bit
1 = A/D conversion cycle in progress. Setting this bit starts an A/D conversion cycle.
This bit is automatically cleared by hardware when the A/D conversion has completed.
0 = A/D conversion completed/not in progress
bit 0
ADON: ADC Enable bit
1 = ADC is enabled
0 = ADC is disabled and consumes no operating current
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 65
PIC12F683
REGISTER 9-2:
ADRESH: ADC RESULT REGISTER HIGH (ADRESH) ADFM = 0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
ADRES9
ADRES8
ADRES7
ADRES6
ADRES5
ADRES4
ADRES3
ADRES2
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
ADRES<9:2>: ADC Result Register bits
Upper 8 bits of 10-bit conversion result
REGISTER 9-3:
ADRESL: ADC RESULT REGISTER LOW (ADRESL) ADFM = 0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
ADRES1
ADRES0
—
—
—
—
—
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-6
ADRES<1:0>: ADC Result Register bits
Lower 2 bits of 10-bit conversion result
bit 5-0
Reserved: Do not use.
REGISTER 9-4:
x = Bit is unknown
ADRESH: ADC RESULT REGISTER HIGH (ADRESH) ADFM = 1
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADRES9
ADRES8
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-2
Reserved: Do not use.
bit 1-0
ADRES<9:8>: ADC Result Register bits
Upper 2 bits of 10-bit conversion result
REGISTER 9-5:
x = Bit is unknown
ADRESL: ADC RESULT REGISTER LOW (ADRESL) ADFM = 1
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
ADRES7
ADRES6
ADRES5
ADRES4
ADRES3
ADRES2
ADRES1
ADRES0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
ADRES<7:0>: ADC Result Register bits
Lower 8 bits of 10-bit conversion result
DS41211D-page 66
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
9.3
A/D Acquisition Requirements
For the ADC to meet its specified accuracy, the charge
holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed to fully
charge to the input channel voltage level. The Analog
Input model is shown in Figure 9-4. The source
impedance (RS) and the internal sampling switch (RSS)
impedance directly affect the time required to charge the
capacitor CHOLD. The sampling switch (RSS) impedance
varies over the device voltage (VDD), see Figure 9-4.
The maximum recommended impedance for analog
sources is 10 kΩ. As the source impedance is
decreased, the acquisition time may be decreased.
After the analog input channel is selected (or changed),
EQUATION 9-1:
an A/D acquisition must be done before the conversion
can be started. To calculate the minimum acquisition
time, Equation 9-1 may be used. This equation
assumes that 1/2 LSb error is used (1024 steps for the
ADC). The 1/2 LSb error is the maximum error allowed
for the ADC to meet its specified resolution.
ACQUISITION TIME EXAMPLE
Temperature = 50°C and external impedance of 10k Ω 5.0V V DD
Assumptions:
T ACQ = Amplifier Settling Time + Hold Capacitor Charging Time + Temperature Coefficient
= T AMP + T C + T COFF
= 2µs + T C + [ ( Temperature - 25°C ) ( 0.05µs/°C ) ]
The value for TC can be approximated with the following equations:
1
V AP PLIE D ⎛ 1 – ------------⎞ = V CHOLD
⎝
2047⎠
;[1] VCHOLD charged to within 1/2 lsb
–TC
----------⎞
⎛
RC
V AP P LI ED ⎜ 1 – e ⎟ = V CHOLD
⎝
⎠
;[2] VCHOLD charge response to VAPPLIED
– Tc
---------⎞
⎛
1
RC
V AP P LIED ⎜ 1 – e ⎟ = V A P PLIE D ⎛ 1 – ------------⎞
⎝
2047⎠
⎝
⎠
;combining [1] and [2]
Solving for TC:
T C = – C HOLD ( R IC + R SS + R S ) ln(1/2047)
= – 10pF ( 1k Ω + 7k Ω + 10k Ω ) ln(0.0004885)
= 1.37 µs
Therefore:
T ACQ = 2µ S + 1.37µ S + [ ( 50°C- 25°C ) ( 0.05µ S /°C ) ]
= 4.67µ S
Note 1: The reference voltage (VREF) has no effect on the equation, since it cancels itself out.
2: The charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) is not discharged after each conversion.
3: The maximum recommended impedance for analog sources is 10 kΩ. This is required to meet the pin
leakage specification.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 67
PIC12F683
FIGURE 9-4:
ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
ANx
Rs
CPIN
5 pF
VA
VT = 0.6V
VT = 0.6V
RIC ≤ 1k
Sampling
Switch
SS Rss
I LEAKAGE
± 500 nA
CHOLD = 10 pF
VSS/VREF-
Legend: CPIN
= Input Capacitance
= Threshold Voltage
VT
I LEAKAGE = Leakage current at the pin due to
various junctions
RIC
= Interconnect Resistance
SS
= Sampling Switch
CHOLD
= Sample/Hold Capacitance
FIGURE 9-5:
6V
5V
VDD 4V
3V
2V
RSS
5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Sampling Switch
(kΩ)
ADC TRANSFER FUNCTION
Full-Scale Range
3FFh
3FEh
ADC Output Code
3FDh
3FCh
1 LSB ideal
3FBh
Full-Scale
Transition
004h
003h
002h
001h
000h
Analog Input Voltage
1 LSB ideal
VSS/VREF-
DS41211D-page 68
Zero-Scale
Transition
VDD/VREF+
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
TABLE 9-2:
SUMMARY OF ASSOCIATED ADC REGISTERS
Name
Bit 7
ADCON0
ADFM
VCFG
—
ADCS2
ANSEL
Bit 6
Bit 5
Value on
all other
Resets
Value on
POR, BOR
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
—
—
CHS1
CHS0
GO/DONE
ADON
00-- 0000
0000 0000
ADCS1
ADCS0
ANS3
ANS2
ANS1
ANS0
-000 1111
-000 1111
uuuu uuuu
ADRESH
A/D Result Register High Byte
xxxx xxxx
ADRESL
A/D Result Register Low Byte
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
0000 000x
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
PIE1
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
PIR1
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
GPIO
—
—
GP5
GP4
GP3
GP2
GP1
GP0
—
—
TRISIO5
TRISIO4
TRISIO3
TRISIO2
TRISIO1
TRISIO
Legend:
000- 0000
000- 0000
0000 0000
000- 0000
--xx xxxx
--uu uuuu
TRISIO0 --11 1111
--11 1111
x = unknown, u = unchanged, — = unimplemented read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for ADC module.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 69
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 70
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
10.0
DATA EEPROM MEMORY
The EEPROM data memory is readable and writable
during normal operation (full VDD range). This memory
is not directly mapped in the register file space.
Instead, it is indirectly addressed through the Special
Function Registers. There are four SFRs used to read
and write this memory:
•
•
•
•
EECON1
EECON2 (not a physically implemented register)
EEDAT
EEADR
EEDAT holds the 8-bit data for read/write, and EEADR
holds the address of the EEPROM location being
accessed. PIC12F683 has 256 bytes of data EEPROM
with an address range from 0h to FFh.
REGISTER 10-1:
The EEPROM data memory allows byte read and write.
A byte write automatically erases the location and
writes the new data (erase before write). The EEPROM
data memory is rated for high erase/write cycles. The
write time is controlled by an on-chip timer. The write
time will vary with voltage and temperature as well as
from chip-to-chip. Please refer to AC Specifications in
Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications” for exact
limits.
When the data memory is code-protected, the CPU
may continue to read and write the data EEPROM
memory. The device programmer can no longer access
the data EEPROM data and will read zeroes.
EEDAT: EEPROM DATA REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
EEDAT7
EEDAT6
EEDAT5
EEDAT4
EEDAT3
EEDAT2
EEDAT1
EEDAT0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
EEDATn: Byte Value to Write To or Read From Data EEPROM bits
REGISTER 10-2:
EEADR: EEPROM ADDRESS REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
EEADR7
EEADR6
EEADR5
EEADR4
EEADR3
EEADR2
EEADR1
EEADR0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-0
x = Bit is unknown
EEADR: Specifies One of 256 Locations for EEPROM Read/Write Operation bits
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 71
PIC12F683
10.1
EECON1 and EECON2 Registers
EECON1 is the control register with four low-order bits
physically implemented. The upper four bits are nonimplemented and read as ‘0’s.
Control bits RD and WR initiate read and write,
respectively. These bits cannot be cleared, only set in
software. They are cleared in hardware at completion
of the read or write operation. The inability to clear the
WR bit in software prevents the accidental, premature
termination of a write operation.
The WREN bit, when set, will allow a write operation.
On power-up, the WREN bit is clear. The WRERR bit is
set when a write operation is interrupted by a MCLR
Reset, or a WDT Time-out Reset during normal
REGISTER 10-3:
operation. In these situations, following Reset, the user
can check the WRERR bit, clear it and rewrite the
location. The data and address will be cleared.
Therefore, the EEDAT and EEADR registers will need
to be re-initialized.
Interrupt flag, EEIF bit of the PIR1 register, is set when
write is complete. This bit must be cleared in software.
EECON2 is not a physical register. Reading EECON2
will read all ‘0’s. The EECON2 register is used
exclusively in the data EEPROM write sequence.
Note:
The EECON1, EEDAT and EEADR
registers should not be modified during a
data EEPROM write (WR bit = 1).
EECON1: EEPROM CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-0
R/S-0
R/S-0
—
—
—
—
WRERR
WREN
WR
RD
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
S = Bit can only be set
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3
WRERR: EEPROM Error Flag bit
1 = A write operation is prematurely terminated (any MCLR Reset, any WDT Reset during
normal operation or BOR Reset)
0 = The write operation completed
bit 2
WREN: EEPROM Write Enable bit
1 = Allows write cycles
0 = Inhibits write to the data EEPROM
bit 1
WR: Write Control bit
1 = Initiates a write cycle (The bit is cleared by hardware once write is complete. The WR bit can only
be set, not cleared, in software.)
0 = Write cycle to the data EEPROM is complete
bit 0
RD: Read Control bit
1 = Initiates an EEPROM read (Read takes one cycle. RD is cleared in hardware. The RD bit can only
be set, not cleared, in software.)
0 = Does not initiate an EEPROM read
DS41211D-page 72
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
10.2
Reading the EEPROM Data
Memory
To read a data memory location, the user must write the
address to the EEADR register and then set control bit
RD of the EECON1 register, as shown in Example 10-1.
The data is available, at the very next cycle, in the
EEDAT register. Therefore, it can be read in the next
instruction. EEDAT holds this value until another read, or
until it is written to by the user (during a write operation).
EXAMPLE 10-1:
DATA EEPROM READ
BANKSEL
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
MOVF
EEADR
;
CONFIG_ADDR ;
EEADR
;Address to read
EECON1,RD ;EE Read
EEDAT,W
;Move data to W
10.3
Writing to the EEPROM Data
Memory
To write an EEPROM data location, the user must first
write the address to the EEADR register and the data
to the EEDAT register. Then the user must follow a
specific sequence to initiate the write for each byte, as
shown in Example 10-2.
Required
Sequence
EXAMPLE 10-2:
BANKSEL
BSF
BCF
BTFSC
GOTO
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
BSF
DATA EEPROM WRITE
EECON1
EECON1,WREN
INTCON,GIE
INTCON,GIE
$-2
55h
EECON2
AAh
EECON2
EECON1,WR
INTCON,GIE
;
;Enable write
;Disable INTs
;See AN576
;
;Unlock write
;
;
;
;Start the write
;Enable INTS
The write will not initiate if the above sequence is not
exactly followed (write 55h to EECON2, write AAh to
EECON2, then set WR bit) for each byte. We strongly
recommend that interrupts be disabled during this
code segment. A cycle count is executed during the
required sequence. Any number that is not equal to the
required cycles to execute the required sequence will
prevent the data from being written into the EEPROM.
After a write sequence has been initiated, clearing the
WREN bit will not affect this write cycle. The WR bit will
be inhibited from being set unless the WREN bit is set.
At the completion of the write cycle, the WR bit is
cleared in hardware and the EE Write Complete
Interrupt Flag bit (EEIF) is set. The user can either
enable this interrupt or poll this bit. The EEIF bit of the
PIR1 register must be cleared by software.
10.4
Write Verify
Depending on the application, good programming
practice may dictate that the value written to the data
EEPROM should be verified (see Example 10-3) to the
desired value to be written.
EXAMPLE 10-3:
WRITE VERIFY
BANKSELEEDAT
MOVF
EEDAT,W
BSF
EECON1,RD
XORWF
BTFSS
GOTO
:
EEDAT,W
STATUS,Z
WRITE_ERR
10.4.1
;
;EEDAT not changed
;from previous write
;YES, Read the
;value written
;Is data the same
;No, handle error
;Yes, continue
USING THE DATA EEPROM
The data EEPROM is a high-endurance, byte
addressable array that has been optimized for the
storage of frequently changing information (e.g.,
program variables or other data that are updated often).
When variables in one section change frequently, while
variables in another section do not change, it is possible
to exceed the total number of write cycles to the
EEPROM (specification D124) without exceeding the
total number of write cycles to a single byte
(specifications D120 and D120A). If this is the case,
then a refresh of the array must be performed. For this
reason, variables that change infrequently (such as
constants, IDs, calibration, etc.) should be stored in
Flash program memory.
Additionally, the WREN bit in EECON1 must be set to
enable write. This mechanism prevents accidental
writes to data EEPROM due to errant (unexpected)
code execution (i.e., lost programs). The user should
keep the WREN bit clear at all times, except when
updating EEPROM. The WREN bit is not cleared
by hardware.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 73
PIC12F683
10.5
Protection Against Spurious Write
10.6
There are conditions when the user may not want to
write to the data EEPROM memory. To protect against
spurious EEPROM writes, various mechanisms have
been built in. On power-up, WREN is cleared. Also, the
Power-up
Timer
(64 ms
duration)
prevents
EEPROM write.
The write initiate sequence and the WREN bit together
help prevent an accidental write during:
• Brown-out
• Power Glitch
• Software Malfunction
TABLE 10-1:
Name
Data EEPROM Operation During
Code-Protect
Data memory can be code-protected by programming
the CPD bit in the Configuration Word register
(Register 12-1) to ‘0’.
When the data memory is code-protected, the CPU is
able to read and write data to the data EEPROM. It is
recommended to code-protect the program memory
when code-protecting data memory. This prevents
anyone from programming zeroes over the existing
code (which will execute as NOPs) to reach an added
routine, programmed in unused program memory,
which outputs the contents of data memory.
Programming unused locations in program memory to
‘0’ will also help prevent data memory code protection
from becoming breached.
SUMMARY OF ASSOCIATED DATA EEPROM REGISTERS
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Value on
all other
Resets
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000
0000 0000
PIR1
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
000- 0000
000- 0000
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
000- 0000
000- 0000
EEDAT
EEDAT7
EEDAT6
EEDAT5
EEDAT4
EEDAT3
EEDAT2
EEDAT1
EEDAT0
0000 0000
0000 0000
EEADR
EEADR7 EEADR6 EEADR5 EEADR4 EEADR3 EEADR2 EEADR1 EEADR0
0000 0000
0000 0000
PIE1
EECON1
—
—
—
EECON2(1) EEPROM Control Register 2
Legend:
Note 1:
—
WRERR
WREN
WR
RD
---- x000
---- q000
---- ----
---- ----
x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented read as ‘0’, q = value depends upon condition. Shaded cells are not
used by the Data EEPROM module.
EECON2 is not a physical register.
DS41211D-page 74
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
11.0
CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM
(CCP) MODULE
Additional information on CCP modules is available in
the Application Note AN594, “Using the CCP Modules”
(DS00594).
The Capture/Compare/PWM module is a peripheral
which allows the user to time and control different
events. In Capture mode, the peripheral allows the
timing of the duration of an event.The Compare mode
allows the user to trigger an external event when a
predetermined amount of time has expired. The PWM
mode can generate a Pulse-Width Modulated signal of
varying frequency and duty cycle.
TABLE 11-1:
CCP Mode
The timer resources used by the module are shown in
Table 11-1
REGISTER 11-1:
CCP MODE – TIMER
RESOURCES REQUIRED
Timer Resource
Capture
Timer1
Compare
Timer1
PWM
Timer2
CCP1CON: CCP1 CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
DC1B1
DC1B0
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1
CCP1M0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
DC1B<1:0>: PWM Duty Cycle Least Significant bits
Capture mode:
Unused.
Compare mode:
Unused.
PWM mode:
These bits are the two LSbs of the PWM duty cycle. The eight MSbs are found in CCPR1L.
bit 3-0
CCP1M<3:0>: CCP Mode Select bits
0000 = Capture/Compare/PWM off (resets CCP module)
0001 = Unused (reserved)
0010 = Unused (reserved)
0011 = Unused (reserved)
0100 = Capture mode, every falling edge
0101 = Capture mode, every rising edge
0110 = Capture mode, every 4th rising edge
0111 = Capture mode, every 16th rising edge
1000 = Compare mode, set output on match (CCP1IF bit is set)
1001 = Compare mode, clear output on match (CCP1IF bit is set)
1010 = Compare mode, generate software interrupt on match (CCP1IF bit is set, CCP1 pin
is unaffected)
1011 = Compare mode, trigger special event (CCP1IF bit is set, TMR1 is reset and A/D
conversion is started if the ADC module is enabled. CCP1 pin is unaffected.)
110x = PWM mode active-high
111x = PWM mode active-low
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 75
PIC12F683
11.1
11.1.2
Capture Mode
In Capture mode, CCPR1H:CCPR1L captures the
16-bit value of the TMR1 register when an event occurs
on pin CCP1. An event is defined as one of the
following and is configured by the CCP1M<3:0> bits of
the CCP1CON register:
•
•
•
•
Every falling edge
Every rising edge
Every 4th rising edge
Every 16th rising edge
When a capture is made, the Interrupt Request Flag bit
CCP1IF of the PIR1 register is set. The interrupt flag
must be cleared in software. If another capture occurs
before the value in the CCPR1H, CCPR1L register pair
is read, the old captured value is overwritten by the new
captured value (see Figure 11-1).
11.1.1
CCP1 PIN CONFIGURATION
In Capture mode, the CCP1 pin should be configured
as an input by setting the associated TRIS control bit.
Note:
If the CCP1 pin is configured as an output,
a write to the GPIO port can cause a
capture condition.
FIGURE 11-1:
Prescaler
÷ 1, 4, 16
CAPTURE MODE
OPERATION BLOCK
DIAGRAM
CCPR1H
and
Edge Detect
11.1.3
SOFTWARE INTERRUPT
When the Capture mode is changed, a false capture
interrupt may be generated. The user should keep the
CCP1IE interrupt enable bit of the PIE1 register clear to
avoid false interrupts. Additionally, the user should
clear the CCP1IF interrupt flag bit of the PIR1 register
following any change in operating mode.
11.1.4
CCP PRESCALER
There are four prescaler settings specified by the
CCP1M<3:0> bits of the CCP1CON register.
Whenever the CCP module is turned off, or the CCP
module is not in Capture mode, the prescaler counter
is cleared. Any Reset will clear the prescaler counter.
Switching from one capture prescaler to another does not
clear the prescaler and may generate a false interrupt. To
avoid this unexpected operation, turn the module off by
clearing the CCP1CON register before changing the
prescaler (see Example 11-1).
EXAMPLE 11-1:
CLRF
MOVLW
CCPR1L
Capture
Enable
TMR1H
Timer1 must be running in Timer mode or Synchronized
Counter mode for the CCP module to use the capture
feature. In Asynchronous Counter mode, the capture
operation may not work.
CHANGING BETWEEN
CAPTURE PRESCALERS
BANKSEL CCP1CON
Set Flag bit CCP1IF
(PIR1 register)
CCP1
pin
TIMER1 MODE SELECTION
MOVWF
;Set Bank bits to point
;to CCP1CON
CCP1CON
;Turn CCP module off
NEW_CAPT_PS ;Load the W reg with
; the new prescaler
; move value and CCP ON
CCP1CON
;Load CCP1CON with this
; value
TMR1L
CCP1CON<3:0>
System Clock (FOSC)
DS41211D-page 76
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
11.2
11.2.2
Compare Mode
In Compare mode, the 16-bit CCPR1 register value is
constantly compared against the TMR1 register pair
value. When a match occurs, the CCP1 module may:
•
•
•
•
•
Toggle the CCP1 output.
Set the CCP1 output.
Clear the CCP1 output.
Generate a Special Event Trigger.
Generate a Software Interrupt.
All Compare modes can generate an interrupt.
FIGURE 11-2:
COMPARE MODE
OPERATION BLOCK
DIAGRAM
CCP1CON<3:0>
Mode Select
Q
S
R
Output
Logic
Match
TRIS
Output Enable
Comparator
TMR1H
TMR1L
Special Event Trigger
Special Event Trigger will:
• Clear TMR1H and TMR1L registers.
• NOT set interrupt flag bit TMR1IF of the PIR1 register.
• Set the GO/DONE bit to start the ADC conversion.
11.2.1
CCP1 PIN CONFIGURATION
The user must configure the CCP1 pin as an output by
clearing the associated TRIS bit.
Note:
SOFTWARE INTERRUPT MODE
When Generate Software Interrupt mode is chosen
(CCP1M<3:0> = 1010), the CCP1 module does not
assert control of the CCP1 pin (see the CCP1CON
register).
11.2.4
SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER
When Special Event Trigger mode is chosen
(CCP1M<3:0> = 1011), the CCP1 module does the
following:
• Resets Timer1
• Starts an ADC conversion if ADC is enabled
The CCP1 module does not assert control of the CCP1
pin in this mode (see the CCP1CON register).
Set CCP1IF Interrupt Flag
(PIR1)
4
CCPR1H CCPR1L
CCP1
Pin
In Compare mode, Timer1 must be running in either
Timer mode or Synchronized Counter mode. The
compare operation may not work in Asynchronous
Counter mode.
11.2.3
The action on the pin is based on the value of the
CCP1M<3:0> control bits of the CCP1CON register.
TIMER1 MODE SELECTION
The Special Event Trigger output of the CCP occurs
immediately upon a match between the TMR1H,
TMR1L register pair and the CCPR1H, CCPR1L
register pair. The TMR1H, TMR1L register pair is not
reset until the next rising edge of the Timer1 clock. This
allows the CCPR1H, CCPR1L register pair to
effectively provide a 16-bit programmable period
register for Timer1.
Note 1: The Special Event Trigger from the CCP
module does not set interrupt flag bit
TMRxIF of the PIR1 register.
2: Removing the match condition by
changing the contents of the CCPR1H
and CCPR1L register pair, between the
clock edge that generates the Special
Event Trigger and the clock edge that
generates the Timer1 Reset, will preclude
the Reset from occurring.
Clearing the CCP1CON register will force
the CCP1 compare output latch to the
default low level. This is not the GPIO I/O
data latch.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 77
PIC12F683
11.3
PWM Mode
The PWM mode generates a Pulse-Width Modulated
signal on the CCP1 pin. The duty cycle, period and
resolution are determined by the following registers:
•
•
•
•
PR2
T2CON
CCPR1L
CCP1CON
FIGURE 11-4:
CCP PWM OUTPUT
Period
Pulse Width
In Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) mode, the CCP
module produces up to a 10-bit resolution PWM output
on the CCP1 pin. Since the CCP1 pin is multiplexed
with the PORT data latch, the TRIS for that pin must be
cleared to enable the CCP1 pin output driver.
Note:
The PWM output (Figure 11-4) has a time base
(period) and a time that the output stays high (duty
cycle).
TMR2 = PR2
TMR2 = CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4>
TMR2 = 0
Clearing the CCP1CON register will
relinquish CCP1 control of the CCP1 pin.
Figure 11-1 shows a simplified block diagram of PWM
operation.
Figure 11-4 shows a typical waveform of the PWM
signal.
For a step-by-step procedure on how to set up the CCP
module for PWM operation, see Section 11.3.7
“Setup for PWM Operation”.
FIGURE 11-3:
SIMPLIFIED PWM BLOCK
DIAGRAM
CCP1CON<5:4>
Duty Cycle Registers
CCPR1L
CCPR1H(2) (Slave)
CCP1
Pin
R
Comparator
TMR2
(1)
Q
S
TRIS
Comparator
PR2
Note 1:
2:
Clear Timer2,
toggle CCP1 pin and
latch duty cycle
The 8-bit timer TMR2 register is concatenated
with the 2-bit internal system clock (FOSC), or
2 bits of the prescaler, to create the 10-bit time
base.
In PWM mode, CCPR1H is a read-only register.
DS41211D-page 78
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
11.3.1
PWM PERIOD
EQUATION 11-2:
The PWM period is specified by the PR2 register of
Timer2. The PWM period can be calculated using the
formula of Equation 11-1.
EQUATION 11-1:
T OSC • (TMR2 Prescale Value)
EQUATION 11-3:
(TMR2 Prescale Value)
• TMR2 is cleared
• The CCP1 pin is set. (Exception: If the PWM duty
cycle = 0%, the pin will not be set.)
• The PWM duty cycle is latched from CCPR1L into
CCPR1H.
The CCPR1H register and a 2-bit internal latch are
used to double buffer the PWM duty cycle. This double
buffering is essential for glitchless PWM operation.
The 8-bit timer TMR2 register is concatenated with
either the 2-bit internal system clock (FOSC), or 2 bits of
the prescaler, to create the 10-bit time base. The system
clock is used if the Timer2 prescaler is set to 1:1.
The Timer2 postscaler (see Section 7.0
“Timer2 Module”) is not used in the
determination of the PWM frequency.
When the 10-bit time base matches the CCPR1H and 2bit latch, then the CCP1 pin is cleared (see Figure 11-1).
11.3.3
PWM DUTY CYCLE
The PWM duty cycle is specified by writing a 10-bit
value to multiple registers: CCPR1L register and
DC1B<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON register. The
CCPR1L contains the eight MSbs and the CCP1<1:0>
bits of the CCP1CON register contain the two LSbs.
CCPR1L and DC1B<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON
register can be written to at any time. The duty cycle
value is not latched into CCPR1H until after the period
completes (i.e., a match between PR2 and TMR2
registers occurs). While using the PWM, the CCPR1H
register is read-only.
Equation 11-3 is used to calculate the PWM duty cycle
ratio.
The maximum PWM resolution is 10 bits when PR2 is
255. The resolution is a function of the PR2 register
value as shown by Equation 11-4.
EQUATION 11-4:
PWM RESOLUTION
[ 4 ( PR2 + 1 ) ]- bits
Resolution = log
----------------------------------------log ( 2 )
Note:
If the pulse width value is greater than the
period the assigned PWM pin(s) will
remain unchanged.
EXAMPLE PWM FREQUENCIES AND RESOLUTIONS (FOSC = 20 MHz)
PWM Frequency
Timer Prescale (1, 4, 16)
PR2 Value
Maximum Resolution (bits)
TABLE 11-3:
PWM RESOLUTION
The resolution determines the number of available duty
cycles for a given period. For example, a 10-bit resolution
will result in 1024 discrete duty cycles, whereas an 8-bit
resolution will result in 256 discrete duty cycles.
Equation 11-2 is used to calculate the PWM pulse
width.
TABLE 11-2:
DUTY CYCLE RATIO
CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4> -)
Duty Cycle Ratio = (---------------------------------------------------------------------4 ( PR2 + 1 )
When TMR2 is equal to PR2, the following three events
occur on the next increment cycle:
11.3.2
Pulse Width = ( CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4> ) •
PWM PERIOD
PWM Period = [ ( PR2 ) + 1 ] • 4 • T OSC •
Note:
PULSE WIDTH
1.22 kHz
4.88 kHz
19.53 kHz
78.12 kHz
156.3 kHz
208.3 kHz
16
4
1
1
1
1
0xFF
0xFF
0xFF
0x3F
0x1F
0x17
10
10
10
8
7
6.6
EXAMPLE PWM FREQUENCIES AND RESOLUTIONS (FOSC = 8 MHz)
PWM Frequency
Timer Prescale (1, 4, 16)
PR2 Value
Maximum Resolution (bits)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
1.22 kHz
4.90 kHz
19.61 kHz
76.92 kHz
153.85 kHz
200.0 kHz
16
4
1
1
1
1
0x65
0x65
0x65
0x19
0x0C
0x09
8
8
8
6
5
5
DS41211D-page 79
PIC12F683
11.3.4
OPERATION IN SLEEP MODE
In Sleep mode, the TMR2 register will not increment
and the state of the module will not change. If the CCP1
pin is driving a value, it will continue to drive that value.
When the device wakes up, TMR2 will continue from its
previous state.
11.3.5
CHANGES IN SYSTEM CLOCK
FREQUENCY
The PWM frequency is derived from the system clock
frequency. Any changes in the system clock frequency
will result in changes to the PWM frequency. See
Section 3.0 “Oscillator Module (With Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor)” for additional details.
11.3.6
11.3.7
The following steps should be taken when configuring
the CCP module for PWM operation:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
EFFECTS OF RESET
Any Reset will force all ports to Input mode and the
CCP registers to their Reset states.
6.
DS41211D-page 80
SETUP FOR PWM OPERATION
Disable the PWM pin (CCP1) output drivers by
setting the associated TRIS bit.
Set the PWM period by loading the PR2 register.
Configure the CCP module for the PWM mode
by loading the CCP1CON register with the
appropriate values.
Set the PWM duty cycle by loading the CCPR1L
register and DC1B bits of the CCP1CON register.
Configure and start Timer2:
• Clear the TMR2IF interrupt flag bit of the
PIR1 register.
• Set the Timer2 prescale value by loading the
T2CKPS bits of the T2CON register.
• Enable Timer2 by setting the TMR2ON bit of
the T2CON register.
Enable PWM output after a new PWM cycle has
started:
• Wait until Timer2 overflows (TMR2IF bit of
the PIR1 register is set).
• Enable the CCP1 pin output driver by
clearing the associated TRIS bit.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
TABLE 11-4:
Name
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH CAPTURE, COMPARE AND TIMER1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Value on
all other
Resets
—
—
DC1B1
DC1B0
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1
CCP1M0
CCP1CON
--00 0000
--00 0000
CCPR1L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 Low Byte (LSB)
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
CCPR1H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 High Byte (MSB)
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
---- --10
---- --10
CMCON1
—
—
—
—
—
—
T1GSS
CMSYNC
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000
0000 000x
PIE1
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
000- 0000
000- 0000
PIR1
T1CON
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
000- 0000
000- 0000
T1GINV
TMR1GE
T1CKPS1
T1CKPS0
T1OSCEN
T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
0000 0000
0000 0000
TMR1L
Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
TMR1H
Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
--11 1111
--11 1111
TRISIO
Legend:
—
CCP1CON
TRISIO5
TRISIO4
TRISIO3
TRISIO2
TRISIO1
TRISIO0
– = Unimplemented locations, read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown. Shaded cells are not used by the Capture and Compare.
TABLE 11-5:
Name
—
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PWM AND TIMER2
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Value on
all other
Resets
—
—
DC1B1
DC1B0
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1
CCP1M0
--00 0000
--00 0000
CCPR1L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 Low Byte (LSB)
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
CCPR1H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 High Byte (MSB)
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
0000 000x
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000
PIE1
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
000- 0000
-000 0000
PIR1
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
000- 0000
-000 0000
TOUTPS2
TOUTPS1
TOUTPS0
TMR2ON
T2CKPS1
T2CKPS0
TRISIO5
TRISIO4
TRISIO3
TRISIO2
TRISIO1
TRISIO0
PR2
T2CON
TMR2
TRISIO
Legend:
Timer2 Period Register
—
TOUTPS3
Timer2 Module Register
—
—
1111 1111
1111 1111
-000 0000
-000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
--11 1111
--11 1111
– = Unimplemented locations, read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown. Shaded cells are not used by the PWM.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 81
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 82
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
12.0
SPECIAL FEATURES OF THE
CPU
The PIC12F683 has a host of features intended to
maximize system reliability, minimize cost through
elimination of external components, provide power
saving features and offer code protection.
These features are:
• Reset
- Power-on Reset (POR)
- Power-up Timer (PWRT)
- Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
- Brown-out Reset (BOR)
• Interrupts
• Watchdog Timer (WDT)
• Oscillator Selection
• Sleep
• Code Protection
• ID Locations
• In-Circuit Serial Programming™
The PIC12F683 has two timers that offer necessary
delays on power-up. One is the Oscillator Start-up Timer
(OST), intended to keep the chip in Reset until the crystal oscillator is stable. The other is the Power-up Timer
(PWRT), which provides a fixed delay of 64 ms (nominal) on power-up only, designed to keep the part in
Reset while the power supply stabilizes. There is also
circuitry to reset the device if a brown-out occurs, which
can use the Power-up Timer to provide at least a 64 ms
Reset. With these three functions on-chip, most
applications need no external Reset circuitry.
The Sleep mode is designed to offer a very low-current
Power-down mode. The user can wake-up from Sleep
through:
• External Reset
• Watchdog Timer Wake-up
• An interrupt
Several oscillator options are also made available to
allow the part to fit the application. The INTOSC option
saves system cost while the LP crystal option saves
power. A set of Configuration bits are used to select
various options (see Register 12-1).
Note:
12.1
Address 2007h is beyond the user
program memory space. It belongs to the
special configuration memory space
(2000h-3FFFh), which can be accessed
only
during
programming.
See
“PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory Programming Specification” (DS41204) for more
information.
Configuration Bits
The Configuration bits can be programmed (read as
‘0’), or left unprogrammed (read as ‘1’) to select various
device configurations as shown in Register 12-1.
These bits are mapped in program memory location
2007h.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 83
PIC12F683
REGISTER 12-1:
—
CONFIG: CONFIGURATION WORD REGISTER
—
—
—
FCMEN
IESO
BOREN1
BOREN0
bit 15
bit 8
CP
CPD
MCLRE
PWRTE
WDTE
FOSC2
FOSC1
FOSC0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
P = Programmable’
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 15-12
Unimplemented: Read as ‘1’
bit 11
FCMEN: Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Enabled bit
1 = Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled
0 = Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is disabled
bit 10
IESO: Internal External Switchover bit
1 = Internal External Switchover mode is enabled
0 = Internal External Switchover mode is disabled
bit 9-8
BOREN<1:0>: Brown-out Reset Selection bits(1)
11 = BOR enabled
10 = BOR enabled during operation and disabled in Sleep
01 = BOR controlled by SBOREN bit of the PCON register
00 = BOR disabled
bit 7
CPD: Data Code Protection bit(2)
1 = Data memory code protection is disabled
0 = Data memory code protection is enabled
bit 6
CP: Code Protection bit(3)
1 = Program memory code protection is disabled
0 = Program memory code protection is enabled
bit 5
MCLRE: GP3/MCLR pin function select bit(4)
1 = GP3/MCLR pin function is MCLR
0 = GP3/MCLR pin function is digital input, MCLR internally tied to VDD
bit 4
PWRTE: Power-up Timer Enable bit
1 = PWRT disabled
0 = PWRT enabled
bit 3
WDTE: Watchdog Timer Enable bit
1 = WDT enabled
0 = WDT disabled and can be enabled by SWDTEN bit of the WDTCON register
bit 2-0
FOSC<2:0>: Oscillator Selection bits
111 = RC oscillator: CLKOUT function on GP4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, RC on GP5/OSC1/CLKIN
110 = RCIO oscillator: I/O function on GP4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, RC on GP5/OSC1/CLKIN
101 = INTOSC oscillator: CLKOUT function on GP4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, I/O function on GP5/OSC1/CLKIN
100 = INTOSCIO oscillator: I/O function on GP4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, I/O function on GP5/OSC1/CLKIN
011 = EC: I/O function on GP4/OSC2/CLKOUT pin, CLKIN on GP5/OSC1/CLKIN
010 = HS oscillator: High-speed crystal/resonator on GP4/OSC2/CLKOUT and GP5/OSC1/CLKIN
001 = XT oscillator: Crystal/resonator on GP4/OSC2/CLKOUT and GP5/OSC1/CLKIN
000 = LP oscillator: Low-power crystal on GP4/OSC2/CLKOUT and GP5/OSC1/CLKIN
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
Enabling Brown-out Reset does not automatically enable Power-up Timer.
The entire data EEPROM will be erased when the code protection is turned off.
The entire program memory will be erased when the code protection is turned off.
When MCLR is asserted in INTOSC or RC mode, the internal clock oscillator is disabled.
DS41211D-page 84
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
12.2
Calibration Bits
Brown-out Reset (BOR), Power-on Reset (POR) and
8 MHz internal oscillator (HFINTOSC) are factory calibrated. These calibration values are stored in fuses
located in the Calibration Word (2009h). The Calibration Word is not erased when using the specified bulk
erase sequence in the “PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory
Programming Specification” (DS41244) and thus, does
not require reprogramming.
12.3
Reset
The PIC12F683 differentiates between various kinds of
Reset:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f)
Power-on Reset (POR)
WDT Reset during normal operation
WDT Reset during Sleep
MCLR Reset during normal operation
MCLR Reset during Sleep
Brown-out Reset (BOR)
FIGURE 12-1:
Some registers are not affected in any Reset condition;
their status is unknown on POR and unchanged in any
other Reset. Most other registers are reset to a “Reset
state” on:
•
•
•
•
•
Power-on Reset
MCLR Reset
MCLR Reset during Sleep
WDT Reset
Brown-out Reset (BOR)
WDT wake-up does not cause register resets in the
same manner as a WDT Reset since wake-up is
viewed as the resumption of normal operation. TO and
PD bits are set or cleared differently in different Reset
situations, as indicated in Table 12-2. Software can use
these bits to determine the nature of the Reset. See
Table 12-4 for a full description of Reset states of all
registers.
A simplified block diagram of the On-Chip Reset Circuit
is shown in Figure 12-1.
The MCLR Reset path has a noise filter to detect and
ignore small pulses. See Section 15.0 “Electrical
Specifications” for pulse-width specifications.
SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF ON-CHIP RESET CIRCUIT
External
Reset
MCLR/VPP pin
SLEEP
WDT
Module
WDT
Time-out
Reset
VDD Rise
Detect
Power-on Reset
VDD
Brown-out(1)
Reset
BOREN
SBOREN
S
OST/PWRT
OST
Chip_Reset
10-bit Ripple Counter
R
Q
OSC1/
CLKI pin
PWRT
LFINTOSC
11-bit Ripple Counter
Enable PWRT
Enable OST
Note 1: Refer to the Configuration Word register (Register 12-1).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 85
PIC12F683
12.3.1
POWER-ON RESET
The on-chip POR circuit holds the chip in Reset until
VDD has reached a high enough level for proper
operation. To take advantage of the POR, simply
connect the MCLR pin through a resistor to VDD. This
will eliminate external RC components usually needed
to create Power-on Reset. A maximum rise time for
VDD is required. See Section 15.0 “Electrical
Specifications” for details. If the BOR is enabled, the
maximum rise time specification does not apply. The
BOR circuitry will keep the device in Reset until VDD
reaches VBOD (see Section 12.3.4 “Brown-Out Reset
(BOR)”).
Note:
For additional information, refer to the Application Note
AN607, “Power-up Trouble Shooting” (DS00607).
MCLR
PIC12F683 has a noise filter in the MCLR Reset path.
The filter will detect and ignore small pulses.
It should be noted that a WDT Reset does not drive
MCLR pin low.
Voltages applied to the MCLR pin that exceed its
specification can result in both MCLR Resets and
excessive current beyond the device specification
during the ESD event. For this reason, Microchip
recommends that the MCLR pin no longer be tied
directly to VDD. The use of an RC network, as shown in
Figure 12-2, is suggested.
An internal MCLR option is enabled by clearing the
MCLRE bit in the Configuration Word register. When
MCLRE = 0, the Reset signal to the chip is generated
internally. When the MCLRE = 1, the GP3/MCLR pin
becomes an external Reset input. In this mode, the
GP3/MCLR pin has a weak pull-up to VDD.
DS41211D-page 86
RECOMMENDED MCLR
CIRCUIT
VDD
R1
1 kΩ (or greater)
PIC®
MCU
R2
MCLR
SW1
(optional)
100 Ω
(needed with capacitor)
C1
0.1 μF
(optional, not critical)
The POR circuit does not produce an
internal Reset when VDD declines. To
re-enable the POR, VDD must reach Vss
for a minimum of 100 μs.
When the device starts normal operation (exits the
Reset condition), device operating parameters (i.e.,
voltage, frequency, temperature, etc.) must be met to
ensure operation. If these conditions are not met, the
device must be held in Reset until the operating
conditions are met.
12.3.2
FIGURE 12-2:
12.3.3
POWER-UP TIMER (PWRT)
The Power-up Timer provides a fixed 64 ms (nominal)
time-out on power-up only, from POR or Brown-out
Reset. The Power-up Timer operates from the 31 kHz
LFINTOSC oscillator. For more information, see
Section 3.5 “Internal Clock Modes”. The chip is kept
in Reset as long as PWRT is active. The PWRT delay
allows the VDD to rise to an acceptable level. A
Configuration bit, PWRTE, can disable (if set) or enable
(if cleared or programmed) the Power-up Timer. The
Power-up Timer should be enabled when Brown-out
Reset is enabled, although it is not required.
The Power-up Timer delay will vary from chip-to-chip
due to:
• VDD variation
• Temperature variation
• Process variation
See DC parameters for details
“Electrical Specifications”).
Note:
(Section 15.0
Voltage spikes below VSS at the MCLR
pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA,
may cause latch-up. Thus, a series resistor of 50-100 Ω should be used when
applying a “low” level to the MCLR pin,
rather than pulling this pin directly to VSS.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
12.3.4
BROWN-OUT RESET (BOR)
If VDD drops below VBOR while the Power-up Timer is
running, the chip will go back into a Brown-out Reset
and the Power-up Timer will be re-initialized. Once VDD
rises above VBOR, the Power-up Timer will execute a
64 ms Reset.
The BOREN0 and BOREN1 bits in the Configuration
Word register select one of four BOR modes. Two
modes have been added to allow software or hardware
control of the BOR enable. When BOREN<1:0> = 01,
the SBOREN bit of the PCON register enables/disables
the BOR, allowing it to be controlled in software. By
selecting BOREN<1:0> = 10, the BOR is automatically
disabled in Sleep to conserve power and enabled on
wake-up. In this mode, the SBOREN bit is disabled.
See Register 12-1 for the Configuration Word
definition.
12.3.5
The PIC12F683 stores the BOR calibration values in
fuses located in the Calibration Word register (2008h).
The Calibration Word register is not erased when using
the specified bulk erase sequence in the
“PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory Programming Specification” (DS41204) and thus, does not require
reprogramming.
A brown-out occurs when VDD falls below VBOR for
greater than parameter TBOR (see Section 15.0
“Electrical Specifications”). The brown-out condition
will reset the device. This will occur regardless of VDD
slew rate. A Brown-out Reset may not occur if VDD falls
below VBOR for less than parameter TBOR.
Note:
On any Reset (Power-on, Brown-out Reset, Watchdog
Timer, etc.), the chip will remain in Reset until VDD rises
above VBOR (see Figure 12-3). If enabled, the
Power-up Timer will be invoked by the Reset and keep
the chip in Reset an additional 64 ms.
Note:
BOR CALIBRATION
Address 2008h is beyond the user program memory space. It belongs to the
special configuration memory space
(2000h-3FFFh), which can be accessed
only
during
programming.
See
“PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory Programming Specification” (DS41204) for more
information.
The Power-up Timer is enabled by the
PWRTE bit in the Configuration Word
register.
FIGURE 12-3:
BROWN-OUT SITUATIONS
VDD
Internal
Reset
VBOR
64 ms(1)
VDD
Internal
Reset
VBOR
< 64 ms
64 ms(1)
VDD
Internal
Reset
Note 1:
VBOR
64 ms(1)
64 ms delay only if PWRTE bit is programmed to ‘0’.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 87
PIC12F683
12.3.6
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE
12.3.7
POWER CONTROL (PCON)
REGISTER
On power-up, the time-out sequence is as follows:
The Power Control register PCON (address 8Eh) has
two Status bits to indicate what type of Reset occurred
last.
• PWRT time-out is invoked after POR has expired.
• OST is activated after the PWRT time-out has
expired.
Bit 0 is BOR (Brown-out). BOR is unknown on
Power-on Reset. It must then be set by the user and
checked on subsequent Resets to see if BOR = 0,
indicating that a Brown-out has occurred. The BOR
Status bit is a “don’t care” and is not necessarily
predictable if the brown-out circuit is disabled
(BOREN<1:0> = 00 in the Configuration Word
register).
The total time-out will vary based on oscillator
configuration and PWRTE bit status. For example, in EC
mode with PWRTE bit erased (PWRT disabled), there
will be no time-out at all. Figure 12-4, Figure 12-5 and
Figure 12-6 depict time-out sequences. The device can
execute code from the INTOSC while OST is active by
enabling Two-Speed Start-up or Fail-Safe Monitor (see
Section 3.7.2 “Two-Speed Start-up Sequence” and
Section 3.8 “Fail-Safe Clock Monitor”).
Bit 1 is POR (Power-on Reset). It is a ‘0’ on Power-on
Reset and unaffected otherwise. The user must write a
‘1’ to this bit following a Power-on Reset. On a subsequent Reset, if POR is ‘0’, it will indicate that a
Power-on Reset has occurred (i.e., VDD may have
gone too low).
Since the time-outs occur from the POR pulse, if MCLR
is kept low long enough, the time-outs will expire. Then,
bringing MCLR high will begin execution immediately
(see Figure 12-5). This is useful for testing purposes or
to synchronize more than one PIC12F683 device
operating in parallel.
For more information, see Section 4.2.4 “Ultra
Low-Power
Wake-up”
and
Section 12.3.4
“Brown-Out Reset (BOR)”.
Table 12-5 shows the Reset conditions for some
special registers, while Table 12-4 shows the Reset
conditions for all the registers.
TABLE 12-1:
TIME-OUT IN VARIOUS SITUATIONS
Power-up
Brown-out Reset
PWRTE = 0
PWRTE = 1
PWRTE = 0
PWRTE = 1
Wake-up from
Sleep
TPWRT + 1024 •
TOSC
1024 • TOSC
TPWRT + 1024 •
TOSC
1024 • TOSC
1024 • TOSC
TPWRT
—
TPWRT
—
—
Oscillator Configuration
XT, HS, LP
RC, EC, INTOSC
TABLE 12-2:
STATUS/PCON BITS AND THEIR SIGNIFICANCE
POR
BOR
TO
PD
Condition
0
x
1
1
Power-on Reset
u
0
1
1
Brown-out Reset
u
u
0
u
WDT Reset
u
u
0
0
WDT Wake-up
u
u
u
u
MCLR Reset during normal operation
u
u
1
0
MCLR Reset during Sleep
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown
TABLE 12-3:
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH BROWN-OUT RESET
Name
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Value on
all other
Resets(1)
CONFIG(2)
BOREN1
BOREN0
CPD
CP
MCLRE
PWRTE
WDTE
FOSC2
FOSC1
FOSC0
—
—
—
—
POR
BOR
--01 --qq
--0u --uu
PD
Z
DC
C
0001 1xxx
000q quuu
PCON
STATUS
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
—
—
IRP
RP1
ULPWUE SBOREN
RP0
TO
u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition. Shaded cells are not used by BOR.
Other (non Power-up) Resets include MCLR Reset and Watchdog Timer Reset during normal operation.
See Configuration Word register (Register 12-1) for operation of all register bits.
DS41211D-page 88
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 12-4:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (DELAYED MCLR)
VDD
MCLR
Internal POR
TPWRT
PWRT Time-out
TOST
OST Time-out
Internal Reset
FIGURE 12-5:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (DELAYED MCLR)
VDD
MCLR
Internal POR
TPWRT
PWRT Time-out
TOST
OST Time-out
Internal Reset
FIGURE 12-6:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR WITH VDD)
VDD
MCLR
Internal POR
TPWRT
PWRT Time-out
TOST
OST Time-out
Internal Reset
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 89
PIC12F683
TABLE 12-4:
Register
W
INDF
TMR0
INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR REGISTERS
Address
Power-on Reset
MCLR Reset
WDT Reset
Brown-out Reset(1)
Wake-up from Sleep
through Interrupt
Wake-up from Sleep through
WDT Time-out
—
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
00h/80h
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
01h
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PCL
02h/82h
0000 0000
0000 0000
PC + 1(3)
STATUS
03h/83h
0001 1xxx
000q quuu(4)
uuuq quuu(4)
FSR
04h/84h
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
GPIO
05h
--x0 x000
--x0 x000
--uu uuuu
PCLATH
0Ah/8Ah
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
INTCON
0Bh/8Bh
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(2)
PIR1
0Ch
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(2)
TMR1L
0Eh
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR1H
0Fh
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T1CON
10h
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
TMR2
11h
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
T2CON
12h
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
CCPR1L
13h
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCPR1H
14h
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCP1CON
15h
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
WDTCON
18h
---0 1000
---0 1000
---u uuuu
CMCON0
19h
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
CMCON1
20h
---- --10
---- --10
---- --uu
ADRESH
1Eh
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
ADCON0
1Fh
00-- 0000
00-- 0000
uu-- uuuu
OPTION_REG
81h
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISIO
85h
--11 1111
--11 1111
--uu uuuu
PIE1
8Ch
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
(1,5)
PCON
8Eh
--01 --0x
--0u --uu
--uu --uu
OSCCON
8Fh
-110 q000
-110 q000
-uuu uuuu
OSCTUNE
90h
---0 0000
---u uuuu
---u uuuu
PR2
92h
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
WPU
95h
--11 -111
--11 -111
uuuu uuuu
IOC
96h
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
VRCON
99h
0-0- 0000
0-0- 0000
u-u- uuuu
EEDAT
9Ah
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
9Bh
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
EEADR
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition.
If VDD goes too low, Power-on Reset will be activated and registers will be affected differently.
One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIR1 will be affected (to cause wake-up).
When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt
vector (0004h).
See Table 12-5 for Reset value for specific condition.
If Reset was due to brown-out, then bit 0 = 0. All other Resets will cause bit 0 = u.
DS41211D-page 90
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
TABLE 12-4:
INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Wake-up from Sleep
through Interrupt
Wake-up from Sleep through
WDT Time-out
Address
Power-on Reset
MCLR Reset
WDT Reset
Brown-out Reset(1)
EECON1
9Ch
---- x000
---- q000
---- uuuu
EECON2
9Dh
---- ----
---- ----
---- ----
ADRESL
9Eh
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
9Fh
-000 1111
-000 1111
-uuu uuuu
Register
ANSEL
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition.
If VDD goes too low, Power-on Reset will be activated and registers will be affected differently.
One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIR1 will be affected (to cause wake-up).
When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt
vector (0004h).
See Table 12-5 for Reset value for specific condition.
If Reset was due to brown-out, then bit 0 = 0. All other Resets will cause bit 0 = u.
TABLE 12-5:
INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR SPECIAL REGISTERS
Condition
Program
Counter
Status
Register
PCON
Register
Power-on Reset
000h
0001 1xxx
--01 --0x
MCLR Reset during Normal Operation
000h
000u uuuu
--0u --uu
MCLR Reset during Sleep
000h
0001 0uuu
--0u --uu
000h
0000 uuuu
--0u --uu
PC + 1
uuu0 0uuu
--uu --uu
WDT Reset
WDT Wake-up
Brown-out Reset
Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep
000h
0001 1uuu
--01 --10
PC + 1(1)
uuu1 0uuu
--uu --uu
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE, is set, the PC is loaded with
the interrupt vector (0004h) after execution of PC + 1.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 91
PIC12F683
12.4
Interrupts
The PIC12F683 has multiple interrupt sources:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
External Interrupt GP2/INT
Timer0 Overflow Interrupt
GPIO Change Interrupts
Comparator Interrupt
A/D Interrupt
Timer1 Overflow Interrupt
Timer2 Match Interrupt
EEPROM Data Write Interrupt
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Interrupt
CCP Interrupt
For external interrupt events, such as the INT pin or
GPIO change interrupt, the interrupt latency will be
three or four instruction cycles. The exact latency
depends upon when the interrupt event occurs (see
Figure 12-8). The latency is the same for one or
two-cycle instructions. Once in the Interrupt Service
Routine, the source(s) of the interrupt can be
determined by polling the interrupt flag bits. The
interrupt flag bit(s) must be cleared in software before
re-enabling interrupts to avoid multiple interrupt
requests.
Note 1: Individual interrupt flag bits are set,
regardless of the status of their
corresponding mask bit or the GIE bit.
2: When an instruction that clears the GIE
bit is executed, any interrupts that were
pending for execution in the next cycle
are ignored. The interrupts, which were
ignored, are still pending to be serviced
when the GIE bit is set again.
The Interrupt Control register (INTCON) and Peripheral
Interrupt Request Register 1 (PIR1) record individual
interrupt requests in flag bits. The INTCON register
also has individual and global interrupt enable bits.
The Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE of the INTCON
register, enables (if set) all unmasked interrupts, or
disables (if cleared) all interrupts. Individual interrupts
can be disabled through their corresponding enable
bits in the INTCON register and PIE1 register. GIE is
cleared on Reset.
When an interrupt is serviced, the following actions
occur automatically:
• The GIE is cleared to disable any further interrupt.
• The return address is pushed onto the stack.
• The PC is loaded with 0004h.
The Return from Interrupt instruction, RETFIE, exits
the interrupt routine, as well as sets the GIE bit, which
re-enables unmasked interrupts.
The following interrupt flags are contained in the
INTCON register:
• INT Pin Interrupt
• GPIO Change Interrupt
• Timer0 Overflow Interrupt
The peripheral interrupt flags are contained in the PIR1
register. The corresponding interrupt enable bit is
contained in the PIE1 register.
The following interrupt flags are contained in the PIR1
register:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
For additional information on Timer1, Timer2,
comparators, ADC, data EEPROM or Enhanced CCP
modules, refer to the respective peripheral section.
12.4.1
GP2/INT INTERRUPT
The external interrupt on the GP2/INT pin is
edge-triggered; either on the rising edge if the INTEDG
bit of the OPTION register is set, or the falling edge, if
the INTEDG bit is clear. When a valid edge appears on
the GP2/INT pin, the INTF bit of the INTCON register is
set. This interrupt can be disabled by clearing the INTE
control bit of the INTCON register. The INTF bit must
be cleared by software in the Interrupt Service Routine
before re-enabling this interrupt. The GP2/INT interrupt
can wake-up the processor from Sleep, if the INTE bit
was set prior to going into Sleep. See Section 12.7
“Power-Down Mode (Sleep)” for details on Sleep and
Figure 12-10 for timing of wake-up from Sleep through
GP2/INT interrupt.
Note:
The ANSEL and CMCON0 registers must
be initialized to configure an analog
channel as a digital input. Pins configured
as analog inputs will read ‘0’ and cannot
generate an interrupt.
EEPROM Data Write Interrupt
A/D Interrupt
Comparator Interrupt
Timer1 Overflow Interrupt
Timer2 Match Interrupt
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Interrupt
CCP Interrupt
DS41211D-page 92
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
12.4.2
TIMER0 INTERRUPT
12.4.3
An overflow (FFh → 00h) in the TMR0 register will set
the T0IF (INTCON<2>) bit. The interrupt can be
enabled/disabled by setting/clearing the T0IE bit of the
INTCON register. See Section 5.0 “Timer0 Module”
for operation of the Timer0 module.
An input change on GPIO change sets the GPIF bit of
the INTCON register. The interrupt can be
enabled/disabled by setting/clearing the GPIE bit of the
INTCON register. Plus, individual pins can be
configured through the IOC register.
Note:
FIGURE 12-7:
GPIO INTERRUPT
If a change on the I/O pin should occur
when any GPIO operation is being
executed, then the GPIF interrupt flag may
not get set.
INTERRUPT LOGIC
IOC-GP0
IOC0
IOC-GP1
IOC1
IOC-GP2
IOC2
IOC-GP3
IOC3
IOC-GP4
IOC4
IOC-GP5
IOC5
TMR2IF
TMR2IE
TMR1IF
TMR1IE
CMIF
CMIE
ADIF
ADIE
T0IF
T0IE
INTF
INTE
GPIF
GPIE
Wake-up (If in Sleep mode)
Interrupt to CPU
PEIE
GIE
EEIF
EEIE
OSFIF
OSFIE
CCP1IF
CCP1IE
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 93
PIC12F683
FIGURE 12-8:
INT PIN INTERRUPT TIMING
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
OSC1
CLKOUT (3)
(4)
INT pin
(1)
(1)
INTF flag
(INTCON reg.)
(5)
Interrupt Latency
(2)
GIE bit
(INTCON reg.)
INSTRUCTION FLOW
PC
Instruction
Fetched
Inst (PC + 1)
Inst (PC)
Instruction
Executed
Note 1:
PC + 1
PC
0004h
—
Dummy Cycle
Inst (PC)
Inst (PC – 1)
PC + 1
0005h
Inst (0004h)
Inst (0005h)
Dummy Cycle
Inst (0004h)
INTF flag is sampled here (every Q1).
2:
Asynchronous interrupt latency = 3-4 TCY. Synchronous latency = 3 TCY, where TCY = instruction cycle time. Latency
is the same whether Inst (PC) is a single cycle or a 2-cycle instruction.
3:
CLKOUT is available only in INTOSC and RC Oscillator modes.
4:
For minimum width of INT pulse, refer to AC specifications in Section 15.0 “Electrical Specifications”.
5:
INTF is enabled to be set any time during the Q4-Q1 cycles.
TABLE 12-6:
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH INTERRUPTS
Value on
all other
Resets
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
INTCON
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
GPIE
T0IF
INTF
GPIF
0000 0000 0000 0000
IOC
—
—
IOC5
IOC4
IOC3
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
--00 0000 --00 0000
PIR1
EEIF
ADIF
CCP1IF
—
CMIF
OSFIF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
000- 0000 000- 0000
PIE1
EEIE
ADIE
CCP1IE
—
CMIE
OSFIE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE 000- 0000 000- 0000
Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented read as ‘0’, q = value depends upon condition.
Shaded cells are not used by the interrupt module.
DS41211D-page 94
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
12.5
Context Saving During Interrupts
Note:
During an interrupt, only the return PC value is saved
on the stack. Typically, users may wish to save key
registers during an interrupt (e.g., W and STATUS
registers). This must be implemented in software.
Since the lower 16 bytes of all banks are common in the
PIC12F683 (see Figure 2-2), temporary holding registers, W_TEMP and STATUS_TEMP, should be placed
in here. These 16 locations do not require banking and
therefore, makes it easier to context save and restore.
The same code shown in Example 12-1 can be used
to:
•
•
•
•
•
The PIC12F683 normally does not require
saving the PCLATH. However, if computed GOTO’s are used in the ISR and the
main code, the PCLATH must be saved
and restored in the ISR.
Store the W register.
Store the STATUS register.
Execute the ISR code.
Restore the Status (and Bank Select Bit register).
Restore the W register.
EXAMPLE 12-1:
MOVWF
SWAPF
SAVING STATUS AND W REGISTERS IN RAM
W_TEMP
STATUS,W
MOVWF
STATUS_TEMP
:
:(ISR)
:
SWAPF
STATUS_TEMP,W
MOVWF
SWAPF
SWAPF
STATUS
W_TEMP,F
W_TEMP,W
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
;Copy W to TEMP
;Swap status to
;Swaps are used
;Save status to
register
be saved into W
because they do not affect the status bits
bank zero STATUS_TEMP register
;Insert user code here
;Swap STATUS_TEMP register into W
;(sets bank to original state)
;Move W into STATUS register
;Swap W_TEMP
;Swap W_TEMP into W
DS41211D-page 95
PIC12F683
12.6
12.6.2
Watchdog Timer (WDT)
The WDT has the following features:
•
•
•
•
•
Operates from the LFINTOSC (31 kHz)
Contains a 16-bit prescaler
Shares an 8-bit prescaler with Timer0
Time-out period is from 1 ms to 268 seconds
Configuration bit and software controlled
WDT is cleared under certain conditions described in
Table 12-7.
12.6.1
WDT OSCILLATOR
WDT CONTROL
The WDTE bit is located in the Configuration Word
register. When set, the WDT runs continuously.
When the WDTE bit in the Configuration Word register
is set, the SWDTEN bit of the WDTCON register has no
effect. If WDTE is clear, then the SWDTEN bit can be
used to enable and disable the WDT. Setting the bit will
enable it and clearing the bit will disable it.
The PSA and PS<2:0> bits of the OPTION register
have the same function as in previous versions of the
PIC12F683
Family
of
microcontrollers.
See
Section 5.0 “Timer0 Module” for more information.
The WDT derives its time base from the 31 kHz
LFINTOSC. The LTS bit of the OSCCON register does
not reflect that the LFINTOSC is enabled.
The value of WDTCON is ‘---0 1000’ on all Resets.
This gives a nominal time base of 17 ms.
Note:
When the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
is invoked, the WDT is held in Reset,
because the WDT Ripple Counter is used
by the OST to perform the oscillator delay
count. When the OST count has expired,
the WDT will begin counting (if enabled).
FIGURE 12-9:
WATCHDOG TIMER BLOCK DIAGRAM
From Timer0 Clock Source
0
Prescaler(1)
16-bit WDT Prescaler
1
8
PSA
31 kHz
LFINTOSC Clock
PS<2:0>
WDTPS<3:0>
To Timer0
0
1
PSA
WDTE from Configuration Word register
SWDTEN from WDTCON
WDT Time-out
Note
1:
This is the shared Timer0/WDT prescaler. See Section 5.0 “Timer0 Module” for more information.
TABLE 12-7:
WDT STATUS
Conditions
WDT
WDTE = 0
CLRWDT Command
Oscillator Fail Detected
Cleared
Exit Sleep + System Clock = T1OSC, EXTRC, INTRC, EXTCLK
Exit Sleep + System Clock = XT, HS, LP
DS41211D-page 96
Cleared until the end of OST
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
REGISTER 12-2:
WDTCON: WATCHDOG TIMER CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
—
WDTPS3
WDTPS2
WDTPS1
WDTPS0
SWDTEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4-1
WDTPS<3:0>: Watchdog Timer Period Select bits
Bit Value = Prescale Rate
0000 = 1:32
0001 = 1:64
0010 = 1:128
0011 = 1:256
0100 = 1:512 (Reset value)
0101 = 1:1024
0110 = 1:2048
0111 = 1:4096
1000 = 1:8192
1001 = 1:16384
1010 = 1:32768
1011 = 1:65536
1100 = Reserved
1101 = Reserved
1110 = Reserved
1111 = Reserved
bit 0
SWDTEN: Software Enable or Disable the Watchdog Timer(1)
1 = WDT is turned on
0 = WDT is turned off (Reset value)
Note 1:
If WDTE Configuration bit = 1, then WDT is always enabled, irrespective of this control bit. If WDTE
Configuration bit = 0, then it is possible to turn WDT on/off with this control bit.
TABLE 12-8:
Name
WDTCON
Legend:
Note 1:
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH WATCHDOG TIMER
Bit 7
OPTION_REG
CONFIG
x = Bit is unknown
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
WDTPS3 WDTPS2 WSTPS1 WDTPS0 SWDTEN
Value on
POR, BOR
Value on
all other
Resets
—
—
—
---0 1000
---0 1000
GPPU
INTEDG
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
1111 1111
1111 1111
CPD
CP
MCLRE
PWRTE
WDTE
FOSC2
FOSC1
FOSC0
—
—
Shaded cells are not used by the Watchdog Timer.
See Register 12-1 for operation of all Configuration Word register bits.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 97
PIC12F683
12.7
Power-Down Mode (Sleep)
The Power-down mode is entered by executing a
SLEEP instruction.
If the Watchdog Timer is enabled:
•
•
•
•
•
WDT will be cleared but keeps running.
PD bit in the STATUS register is cleared.
TO bit is set.
Oscillator driver is turned off.
I/O ports maintain the status they had before SLEEP
was executed (driving high, low or high-impedance).
For lowest current consumption in this mode, all I/O pins
should be either at VDD or VSS, with no external circuitry
drawing current from the I/O pin and the comparators
and CVREF should be disabled. I/O pins that are
high-impedance inputs should be pulled high or low
externally to avoid switching currents caused by floating
inputs. The T0CKI input should also be at VDD or VSS for
lowest current consumption. The contribution from
on-chip pull-ups on GPIO should be considered.
The MCLR pin must be at a logic high level.
Note:
12.7.1
It should be noted that a Reset generated
by a WDT time-out does not drive MCLR
pin low.
WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP
The device can wake-up from Sleep through one of the
following events:
1.
2.
3.
External Reset input on MCLR pin.
Watchdog Timer wake-up (if WDT was
enabled).
Interrupt from GP2/INT pin, GPIO change or a
peripheral interrupt.
The first event will cause a device Reset. The two latter
events are considered a continuation of program
execution. The TO and PD bits in the STATUS register
can be used to determine the cause of a device Reset.
The PD bit, which is set on power-up, is cleared when
Sleep is invoked. TO bit is cleared if WDT wake-up
occurred.
The following peripheral interrupts can wake the device
from Sleep:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Timer1 interrupt. Timer1 must be operating as
an asynchronous counter.
ECCP Capture mode interrupt.
A/D conversion (when A/D clock source is FRC).
EEPROM write operation completion.
Comparator output changes state.
Interrupt-on-change.
External Interrupt from INT pin.
When the SLEEP instruction is being executed, the next
instruction (PC + 1) is prefetched. For the device to
wake-up through an interrupt event, the corresponding
interrupt enable bit must be set (enabled). Wake-up
occurs regardless of the state of the GIE bit. If the GIE
bit is clear (disabled), the device continues execution at
the instruction after the SLEEP instruction. If the GIE bit
is set (enabled), the device executes the instruction
after the SLEEP instruction, then branches to the interrupt address (0004h). In cases where the execution of
the instruction following SLEEP is not desirable, the
user should have a NOP after the SLEEP instruction.
Note:
If the global interrupts are disabled (GIE is
cleared) and any interrupt source has both
its interrupt enable bit and the corresponding interrupt flag bits set, the device will
immediately wake-up from Sleep.
The WDT is cleared when the device wakes up from
Sleep, regardless of the source of wake-up.
12.7.2
WAKE-UP USING INTERRUPTS
When global interrupts are disabled (GIE cleared) and
any interrupt source has both its interrupt enable bit
and interrupt flag bit set, one of the following will occur:
• If the interrupt occurs before the execution of a
SLEEP instruction, the SLEEP instruction will
complete as a NOP. Therefore, the WDT and WDT
prescaler and postscaler (if enabled) will not be
cleared, the TO bit will not be set and the PD bit
will not be cleared.
• If the interrupt occurs during or after the
execution of a SLEEP instruction, the device will
Immediately wake-up from Sleep. The SLEEP
instruction is executed. Therefore, the WDT and
WDT prescaler and postscaler (if enabled) will be
cleared, the TO bit will be set and the PD bit will
be cleared.
Even if the flag bits were checked before executing a
SLEEP instruction, it may be possible for flag bits to
become set before the SLEEP instruction completes. To
determine whether a SLEEP instruction executed, test
the PD bit. If the PD bit is set, the SLEEP instruction
was executed as a NOP.
To ensure that the WDT is cleared, a CLRWDT instruction
should be executed before a SLEEP instruction. See
Figure 12-10 for more details.
Other peripherals cannot generate interrupts since
during Sleep, no on-chip clocks are present.
DS41211D-page 98
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 12-10:
WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP THROUGH INTERRUPT
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
OSC1
TOST(2)
CLKOUT(4)
INT pin
INTF flag
(INTCON<1>)
Interrupt Latency (3)
GIE bit
(INTCON<7>)
Instruction Flow
PC
PC
Instruction
Fetched Inst(PC) = Sleep
Instruction
Inst(PC – 1)
Executed
Note
12.8
1:
2:
3:
4:
Processor in
Sleep
PC + 1
PC + 2
PC + 2
Inst(PC + 1)
Inst(PC + 2)
Sleep
Inst(PC + 1)
PC + 2
Dummy Cycle
0004h
0005h
Inst(0004h)
Inst(0005h)
Dummy Cycle
Inst(0004h)
XT, HS or LP Oscillator mode assumed.
TOST = 1024 TOSC (drawing not to scale). This delay does not apply to EC and RCIO Oscillator modes.
GIE = 1 assumed. In this case after wake-up, the processor jumps to 0004h. If GIE = 0, execution will continue in-line.
CLKOUT is not available in XT, HS, LP or EC Oscillator modes, but shown here for timing reference.
Code Protection
If the code protection bit(s) have not been
programmed, the on-chip program memory can be
read out using ICSP™ for verification purposes.
Note:
12.9
The entire data EEPROM and Flash program memory will be erased when the
code protection is turned off. See the
“PIC12F6XX/16F6XX Memory
Programming Specification” (DS41204)
for more information.
ID Locations
Four memory locations (2000h-2003h) are designated
as ID locations where the user can store checksum or
other code identification numbers. These locations are
not accessible during normal execution, but are
readable and writable during Program/Verify mode.
Only the Least Significant 7 bits of the ID locations are
used.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 99
PIC12F683
12.10 In-Circuit Serial Programming™
12.11 In-Circuit Debugger
The PIC12F683 microcontrollers can be serially
programmed while in the end application circuit. This is
simply done with five connections for:
Since in-circuit debugging requires access to three
pins, MPLAB® ICD 2 development with a 14-pin device
is not practical. A special 14-pin PIC12F683 ICD device
is used with MPLAB ICD 2 to provide separate clock,
data and MCLR pins and frees all normally available
pins to the user.
clock
data
power
ground
programming voltage
A special debugging adapter allows the ICD device to
be used in place of a PIC12F683 device. The
debugging adapter is the only source of the ICD device.
This allows customers to manufacture boards with
unprogrammed devices and then program the microcontroller just before shipping the product. This also
allows the most recent firmware or a custom firmware
to be programmed.
The device is placed into a Program/Verify mode by
holding the GP0 and GP1 pins low, while raising the
MCLR (VPP) pin from VIL to VIHH. See the
“PIC12F6XX/16F6XX
Memory
Programming
Specification” (DS41204) for more information. GP0
becomes the programming data and GP1 becomes the
programming clock. Both GP0 and GP1 are Schmitt
Trigger inputs in Program/Verify mode.
A typical In-Circuit Serial Programming connection is
shown in Figure 12-11.
FIGURE 12-11:
TYPICAL IN-CIRCUIT
SERIAL PROGRAMMING
CONNECTION
To Normal
Connections
External
Connector
Signals
*
When the ICD pin on the PIC12F683 ICD device is held
low, the In-Circuit Debugger functionality is enabled.
This function allows simple debugging functions when
used with MPLAB ICD 2. When the microcontroller has
this feature enabled, some of the resources are not
available for general use. Table 12-9 shows which
features are consumed by the background debugger.
TABLE 12-9:
DEBUGGER RESOURCES
Resource
Description
Stack
1 level
Program Memory
Address 0h must be NOP
700h-7FFh
For more information, see “MPLAB® ICD 2 In-Circuit
Debugger User’s Guide” (DS51331), available on
Microchip’s web site (www.microchip.com).
FIGURE 12-12:
14-PIN ICD PINOUT
14-Pin PDIP
In-Circuit Debug Device
PIC12F683
+5V
VDD
0V
VSS
NC
1
ICDMCLR
2
VDD
3
VPP
MCLR/VPP/GP3
GP5
4
CLK
GP1
GP4
5
GP3
6
ICD
7
GP0
Data I/O
*
*
PIC12F683-ICD
•
•
•
•
•
14
ICDCLK
13
ICDDATA
12
GND
11
GP0
10
GP1
9
GP2
8
NC
*
To Normal
Connections
* Isolation devices (as required)
DS41211D-page 100
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
13.0
INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY
The PIC12F683 instruction set is highly orthogonal and
is comprised of three basic categories:
• Byte-oriented operations
• Bit-oriented operations
• Literal and control operations
Each PIC16 instruction is a 14-bit word divided into an
opcode, which specifies the instruction type and one or
more operands, which further specify the operation of
the instruction. The formats for each of the categories
is presented in Figure 13-1, while the various opcode
fields are summarized in Table 13-1.
TABLE 13-1:
Field
The destination designator specifies where the result of
the operation is to be placed. If ‘d’ is zero, the result is
placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is one, the result is placed
in the file register specified in the instruction.
For bit-oriented instructions, ‘b’ represents a bit field
designator, which selects the bit affected by the
operation, while ‘f’ represents the address of the file in
which the bit is located.
For literal and control operations, ‘k’ represents an
8-bit or 11-bit constant, or literal value.
One instruction cycle consists of four oscillator periods;
for an oscillator frequency of 4 MHz, this gives a
nominal instruction execution time of 1 μs. All
instructions are executed within a single instruction
cycle, unless a conditional test is true, or the program
counter is changed as a result of an instruction. When
this occurs, the execution takes two instruction cycles,
with the second cycle executed as a NOP.
All instruction examples use the format ‘0xhh’ to
represent a hexadecimal number, where ‘h’ signifies a
hexadecimal digit.
Description
Register file address (0x00 to 0x7F)
f
W
Working register (accumulator)
b
Bit address within an 8-bit file register
k
Literal field, constant data or label
x
Don’t care location (= 0 or 1).
The assembler will generate code with x = 0.
It is the recommended form of use for
compatibility with all Microchip software tools.
d
Destination select; d = 0: store result in W,
d = 1: store result in file register f.
Default is d = 1.
Table 13-2 lists the instructions recognized by the
MPASMTM assembler.
For byte-oriented instructions, ‘f’ represents a file
register designator and ‘d’ represents a destination
designator. The file register designator specifies which
file register is to be used by the instruction.
OPCODE FIELD
DESCRIPTIONS
PC
Program Counter
TO
Time-out bit
Carry bit
C
DC
Digit carry bit
Zero bit
Z
PD
Power-down bit
FIGURE 13-1:
GENERAL FORMAT FOR
INSTRUCTIONS
Byte-oriented file register operations
13
8 7 6
OPCODE
d
f (FILE #)
0
d = 0 for destination W
d = 1 for destination f
f = 7-bit file register address
Bit-oriented file register operations
13
10 9
7 6
OPCODE
b (BIT #)
f (FILE #)
0
b = 3-bit bit address
f = 7-bit file register address
Literal and control operations
General
13.1
Read-Modify-Write Operations
13
8
7
OPCODE
Any instruction that specifies a file register as part of
the instruction performs a Read-Modify-Write (R-M-W)
operation. The register is read, the data is modified,
and the result is stored according to either the instruction, or the destination designator ‘d’. A read operation
is performed on a register even if the instruction writes
to that register.
For example, a CLRF PORTA instruction will read
PORTA, clear all the data bits, then write the result back
to PORTA. This example would have the unintended
consequence of clearing the condition that set the RAIF
flag.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
0
k (literal)
k = 8-bit immediate value
CALL and GOTO instructions only
13
11
OPCODE
10
0
k (literal)
k = 11-bit immediate value
DS41211D-page 101
PIC12F683
TABLE 13-2:
PIC12F683 INSTRUCTION SET
Mnemonic,
Operands
14-Bit Opcode
Description
Cycles
MSb
LSb
Status
Affected
Notes
BYTE-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS
ADDWF
ANDWF
CLRF
CLRW
COMF
DECF
DECFSZ
INCF
INCFSZ
IORWF
MOVF
MOVWF
NOP
RLF
RRF
SUBWF
SWAPF
XORWF
f, d
f, d
f
–
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f
–
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
Add W and f
AND W with f
Clear f
Clear W
Complement f
Decrement f
Decrement f, Skip if 0
Increment f
Increment f, Skip if 0
Inclusive OR W with f
Move f
Move W to f
No Operation
Rotate Left f through Carry
Rotate Right f through Carry
Subtract W from f
Swap nibbles in f
Exclusive OR W with f
BCF
BSF
BTFSC
BTFSS
f, b
f, b
f, b
f, b
Bit Clear f
Bit Set f
Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
1
1
1
1
1
1
1(2)
1
1(2)
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
dfff
dfff
lfff
0xxx
dfff
dfff
dfff
dfff
dfff
dfff
dfff
lfff
0xx0
dfff
dfff
dfff
dfff
dfff
ffff
ffff
ffff
xxxx
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
0000
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
00bb
01bb
10bb
11bb
bfff
bfff
bfff
bfff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
111x
1001
0kkk
0000
1kkk
1000
00xx
0000
01xx
0000
0000
110x
1010
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
0110
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
0000
kkkk
0000
0110
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
0100
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
1001
kkkk
1000
0011
kkkk
kkkk
0111
0101
0001
0001
1001
0011
1011
1010
1111
0100
1000
0000
0000
1101
1100
0010
1110
0110
C, DC, Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
C
C
C, DC, Z
Z
1, 2
1, 2
2
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2, 3
1, 2
1, 2, 3
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2
BIT-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS
1
1
1 (2)
1 (2)
01
01
01
01
1, 2
1, 2
3
3
LITERAL AND CONTROL OPERATIONS
ADDLW
ANDLW
CALL
CLRWDT
GOTO
IORLW
MOVLW
RETFIE
RETLW
RETURN
SLEEP
SUBLW
XORLW
Note 1:
2:
3:
k
k
k
–
k
k
k
–
k
–
–
k
k
Add literal and W
AND literal with W
Call Subroutine
Clear Watchdog Timer
Go to address
Inclusive OR literal with W
Move literal to W
Return from interrupt
Return with literal in W
Return from Subroutine
Go into Standby mode
Subtract W from literal
Exclusive OR literal with W
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
2
2
2
1
1
1
11
11
10
00
10
11
11
00
11
00
00
11
11
C, DC, Z
Z
TO, PD
Z
TO, PD
C, DC, Z
Z
When an I/O register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF GPIO, 1), the value used will be that value present
on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and is driven low by an external
device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’.
If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and where applicable, d = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if
assigned to the Timer0 module.
If the Program Counter (PC) is modified, or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second
cycle is executed as a NOP.
DS41211D-page 102
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
13.2
Instruction Descriptions
ADDLW
Add literal and W
Syntax:
[ label ] ADDLW
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
(W) + k → (W)
Status Affected:
C, DC, Z
Description:
The contents of the W register
are added to the eight-bit literal ‘k’
and the result is placed in the
W register.
k
BCF
Bit Clear f
Syntax:
[ label ] BCF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
0≤b≤7
Operation:
0 → (f<b>)
Status Affected:
None
Description:
Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is cleared.
BSF
Bit Set f
Syntax:
[ label ] BSF
f,b
ADDWF
Add W and f
Syntax:
[ label ] ADDWF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
0≤b≤7
Operation:
(W) + (f) → (destination)
Operation:
1 → (f<b>)
Status Affected:
C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
None
Description:
Add the contents of the W register
with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in the W register. If
‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in register ‘f’.
Description:
Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is set.
ANDLW
AND literal with W
BTFSC
Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
Syntax:
[ label ] ANDLW
Syntax:
[ label ] BTFSC f,b
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
Operation:
(W) .AND. (k) → (W)
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
0≤b≤7
Status Affected:
Z
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 0
Description:
The contents of W register are
AND’ed with the eight-bit literal
‘k’. The result is placed in the W
register.
Status Affected:
None
Description:
If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘1’, the next
instruction is executed.
If bit ‘b’, in register ‘f’, is ‘0’, the
next instruction is discarded, and
a NOP is executed instead, making
this a 2-cycle instruction.
ANDWF
f,d
k
AND W with f
Syntax:
[ label ] ANDWF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(W) .AND. (f) → (destination)
f,d
Status Affected:
Z
Description:
AND the W register with register
‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in
the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the
result is stored back in register ‘f’.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
f,b
DS41211D-page 103
PIC12F683
BTFSS
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
CLRWDT
Clear Watchdog Timer
Syntax:
[ label ] BTFSS f,b
Syntax:
[ label ] CLRWDT
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
0≤b<7
Operands:
None
Operation:
00h → WDT
0 → WDT prescaler,
1 → TO
1 → PD
Status Affected:
TO, PD
Description:
CLRWDT instruction resets the
Watchdog Timer. It also resets the
prescaler of the WDT.
Status bits TO and PD are set.
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 1
Status Affected:
None
Description:
If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘0’, the next
instruction is executed.
If bit ‘b’ is ‘1’, then the next
instruction is discarded and a NOP
is executed instead, making this a
2-cycle instruction.
CALL
Call Subroutine
COMF
Complement f
Syntax:
[ label ] CALL k
Syntax:
[ label ] COMF
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 2047
Operands:
Operation:
(PC)+ 1→ TOS,
k → PC<10:0>,
(PCLATH<4:3>) → PC<12:11>
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) → (destination)
Status Affected:
Z
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
complemented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’,
the result is stored back in
register ‘f’.
DECF
Decrement f
Syntax:
[ label ] DECF f,d
f,d
Status Affected:
None
Description:
Call Subroutine. First, return
address (PC + 1) is pushed onto
the stack. The eleven-bit
immediate address is loaded into
PC bits <10:0>. The upper bits of
the PC are loaded from PCLATH.
CALL is a two-cycle instruction.
CLRF
Clear f
Syntax:
[ label ] CLRF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Operands:
Operation:
00h → (f)
1→Z
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) - 1 → (destination)
Status Affected:
Z
Status Affected:
Z
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
cleared and the Z bit is set.
Description:
Decrement register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’,
the result is stored in the W
register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’.
CLRW
Clear W
Syntax:
[ label ] CLRW
f
Operands:
None
Operation:
00h → (W)
1→Z
Status Affected:
Z
Description:
W register is cleared. Zero bit (Z)
is set.
DS41211D-page 104
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
DECFSZ
Decrement f, Skip if 0
INCFSZ
Increment f, Skip if 0
Syntax:
[ label ] DECFSZ f,d
Syntax:
[ label ]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) - 1 → (destination);
skip if result = 0
Operation:
(f) + 1 → (destination),
skip if result = 0
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is
‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’.
If the result is ‘1’, the next
instruction is executed. If the
result is ‘0’, then a NOP is
executed instead, making it a
2-cycle instruction.
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is
‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’.
If the result is ‘1’, the next
instruction is executed. If the
result is ‘0’, a NOP is executed
instead, making it a 2-cycle
instruction.
GOTO
Unconditional Branch
IORLW
Syntax:
[ label ]
Syntax:
[ label ]
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 2047
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
k → PC<10:0>
PCLATH<4:3> → PC<12:11>
Operation:
(W) .OR. k → (W)
Status Affected:
Z
Status Affected:
None
Description:
Description:
GOTO is an unconditional branch.
The eleven-bit immediate value is
loaded into PC bits <10:0>. The
upper bits of PC are loaded from
PCLATH<4:3>. GOTO is a
two-cycle instruction.
The contents of the W register are
OR’ed with the eight-bit literal ‘k’.
The result is placed in the
W register.
INCF
Increment f
IORWF
Inclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
[ label ]
Syntax:
[ label ]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) + 1 → (destination)
Operation:
(W) .OR. (f) → (destination)
Status Affected:
Z
Status Affected:
Z
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is
‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’.
Description:
Inclusive OR the W register with
register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is
‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’.
GOTO k
INCF f,d
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
INCFSZ f,d
Inclusive OR literal with W
IORLW k
IORWF
f,d
DS41211D-page 105
PIC12F683
MOVF
Move f
Syntax:
[ label ]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
MOVF f,d
MOVWF
Move W to f
Syntax:
[ label ]
MOVWF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
Operation:
(W) → (f)
f
Operation:
(f) → (dest)
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
Z
Description:
Description:
The contents of register f is
moved to a destination dependent
upon the status of d. If d = 0,
destination is W register. If d = 1,
the destination is file register f
itself. d = 1 is useful to test a file
register since status flag Z is
affected.
Move data from W register to
register ‘f’.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Example:
MOVF
Example:
MOVW
F
OPTION
Before Instruction
OPTION =
W
=
After Instruction
OPTION =
W
=
FSR, 0
0xFF
0x4F
0x4F
0x4F
After Instruction
W =
value in FSR
register
Z = 1
MOVLW
Move literal to W
NOP
No Operation
Syntax:
[ label ]
Syntax:
[ label ]
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
None
Operation:
k → (W)
Operation:
No operation
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Description:
The eight-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into
W register. The “don’t cares” will
assemble as ‘0’s.
Description:
No operation.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Example:
MOVLW k
Example:
MOVLW
NOP
0x5A
After Instruction
W =
DS41211D-page 106
NOP
0x5A
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
RETFIE
Return from Interrupt
RETLW
Return with literal in W
Syntax:
[ label ]
Syntax:
[ label ]
Operands:
None
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
TOS → PC,
1 → GIE
Operation:
k → (W);
TOS → PC
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Description:
Return from Interrupt. Stack is
POPed and Top-of-Stack (TOS) is
loaded in the PC. Interrupts are
enabled by setting Global
Interrupt Enable bit, GIE
(INTCON<7>). This is a two-cycle
instruction.
Description:
The W register is loaded with the
eight bit literal ‘k’. The program
counter is loaded from the top of
the stack (the return address).
This is a two-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Example:
RETFIE
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Example:
RETFIE
After Interrupt
PC =
GIE =
TABLE
TOS
1
RETLW k
CALL TABLE;W contains
table
;offset value
•
;W now has table value
•
•
ADDWF PC ;W = offset
RETLW k1 ;Begin table
RETLW k2 ;
•
•
•
RETLW kn ; End of table
Before Instruction
W = 0x07
After Instruction
W = value of k8
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
RETURN
Return from Subroutine
Syntax:
[ label ]
Operands:
None
Operation:
TOS → PC
Status Affected:
None
Description:
Return from subroutine. The stack
is POPed and the top of the stack
(TOS) is loaded into the program
counter. This is a two-cycle
instruction.
RETURN
DS41211D-page 107
PIC12F683
RLF
Rotate Left f through Carry
SLEEP
Enter Sleep mode
Syntax:
[ label ]
Syntax:
[ label ] SLEEP
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
None
Operation:
Operation:
See description below
Status Affected:
C
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
rotated one bit to the left through
the Carry flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is placed in the W register.
If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored
back in register ‘f’.
00h → WDT,
0 → WDT prescaler,
1 → TO,
0 → PD
RLF
f,d
C
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Example:
Status Affected:
TO, PD
Description:
The power-down Status bit, PD is
cleared. Time-out Status bit, TO
is set. Watchdog Timer and its
prescaler are cleared.
The processor is put into Sleep
mode with the oscillator stopped.
Register f
RLF
REG1,0
Before Instruction
REG1
C
=
=
1110 0110
0
=
=
=
1110 0110
1100 1100
1
After Instruction
REG1
W
C
RRF
Rotate Right f through Carry
SUBLW
Syntax:
[ label ]
Syntax:
[ label ] SUBLW k
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
k - (W) → (W)
Operation:
See description below
Status Affected: C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
C
Description:
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
rotated one bit to the right through
the Carry flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is placed in the W register.
If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed
back in register ‘f’.
RRF f,d
C
DS41211D-page 108
Register f
Subtract W from literal
The W register is subtracted (2’s
complement method) from the
eight-bit literal ‘k’. The result is
placed in the W register.
C=0
W>k
C=1
W≤k
DC = 0
W<3:0> > k<3:0>
DC = 1
W<3:0> ≤ k<3:0>
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
SUBWF
Subtract W from f
XORLW
Exclusive OR literal with W
Syntax:
[ label ] SUBWF f,d
Syntax:
[ label ] XORLW k
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
(f) - (W) → (destination)
Operation:
(W) .XOR. k → (W)
Operation:
Status Affected:
Z
Description:
The contents of the W register
are XOR’ed with the eight-bit
literal ‘k’. The result is placed in
the W register.
Status Affected: C, DC, Z
Description:
SWAPF
Subtract (2’s complement method)
W register from register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is
‘0’, the result is stored in the W
register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f.
C=0
W>f
C=1
W≤f
DC = 0
W<3:0> > f<3:0>
DC = 1
W<3:0> ≤ f<3:0>
Swap Nibbles in f
XORWF
Exclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
[ label ] SWAPF f,d
Syntax:
[ label ] XORWF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 127
d ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f<3:0>) → (destination<7:4>),
(f<7:4>) → (destination<3:0>)
Operation:
(W) .XOR. (f) → (destination)
Status Affected:
Z
Status Affected:
None
Description:
Description:
The upper and lower nibbles of
register ‘f’ are exchanged. If ‘d’ is
‘0’, the result is placed in the W
register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed in register ‘f’.
Exclusive OR the contents of the
W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is
‘0’, the result is stored in the W
register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
f,d
DS41211D-page 109
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 110
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
14.0
DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT
The PIC® microcontrollers are supported with a full
range of hardware and software development tools:
• Integrated Development Environment
- MPLAB® IDE Software
• Assemblers/Compilers/Linkers
- MPASMTM Assembler
- MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 C Compilers
- MPLINKTM Object Linker/
MPLIBTM Object Librarian
- MPLAB ASM30 Assembler/Linker/Library
• Simulators
- MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
• Emulators
- MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator
- MPLAB REAL ICE™ In-Circuit Emulator
• In-Circuit Debugger
- MPLAB ICD 2
• Device Programmers
- PICSTART® Plus Development Programmer
- MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
- PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer
• Low-Cost Demonstration and Development
Boards and Evaluation Kits
14.1
MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment Software
The MPLAB IDE software brings an ease of software
development previously unseen in the 8/16-bit microcontroller market. The MPLAB IDE is a Windows®
operating system-based application that contains:
• A single graphical interface to all debugging tools
- Simulator
- Programmer (sold separately)
- Emulator (sold separately)
- In-Circuit Debugger (sold separately)
• A full-featured editor with color-coded context
• A multiple project manager
• Customizable data windows with direct edit of
contents
• High-level source code debugging
• Visual device initializer for easy register
initialization
• Mouse over variable inspection
• Drag and drop variables from source to watch
windows
• Extensive on-line help
• Integration of select third party tools, such as
HI-TECH Software C Compilers and IAR
C Compilers
The MPLAB IDE allows you to:
• Edit your source files (either assembly or C)
• One touch assemble (or compile) and download
to PIC MCU emulator and simulator tools
(automatically updates all project information)
• Debug using:
- Source files (assembly or C)
- Mixed assembly and C
- Machine code
MPLAB IDE supports multiple debugging tools in a
single development paradigm, from the cost-effective
simulators, through low-cost in-circuit debuggers, to
full-featured emulators. This eliminates the learning
curve when upgrading to tools with increased flexibility
and power.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 111
PIC12F683
14.2
MPASM Assembler
The MPASM Assembler is a full-featured, universal
macro assembler for all PIC MCUs.
The MPASM Assembler generates relocatable object
files for the MPLINK Object Linker, Intel® standard HEX
files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol
reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines
and generated machine code and COFF files for
debugging.
The MPASM Assembler features include:
• Integration into MPLAB IDE projects
• User-defined macros to streamline
assembly code
• Conditional assembly for multi-purpose
source files
• Directives that allow complete control over the
assembly process
14.5
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler produces relocatable
machine code from symbolic assembly language for
dsPIC30F devices. MPLAB C30 C Compiler uses the
assembler to produce its object file. The assembler
generates relocatable object files that can then be
archived or linked with other relocatable object files and
archives to create an executable file. Notable features
of the assembler include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Support for the entire dsPIC30F instruction set
Support for fixed-point and floating-point data
Command line interface
Rich directive set
Flexible macro language
MPLAB IDE compatibility
14.6
14.3
MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30
C Compilers
The MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 Code Development
Systems are complete ANSI C compilers for
Microchip’s PIC18 and PIC24 families of microcontrollers and the dsPIC30 and dsPIC33 family of digital signal controllers. These compilers provide powerful
integration capabilities, superior code optimization and
ease of use not found with other compilers.
For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide
symbol information that is optimized to the MPLAB IDE
debugger.
14.4
MPLINK Object Linker/
MPLIB Object Librarian
The MPLINK Object Linker combines relocatable
objects created by the MPASM Assembler and the
MPLAB C18 C Compiler. It can link relocatable objects
from precompiled libraries, using directives from a
linker script.
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker
and Librarian
MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator allows code
development in a PC-hosted environment by simulating the PIC MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs on an instruction
level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be
examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from
a comprehensive stimulus controller. Registers can be
logged to files for further run-time analysis. The trace
buffer and logic analyzer display extend the power of
the simulator to record and track program execution,
actions on I/O, most peripherals and internal registers.
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator fully supports
symbolic debugging using the MPLAB C18 and
MPLAB C30 C Compilers, and the MPASM and
MPLAB ASM30 Assemblers. The software simulator
offers the flexibility to develop and debug code outside
of the hardware laboratory environment, making it an
excellent, economical software development tool.
The MPLIB Object Librarian manages the creation and
modification of library files of precompiled code. When
a routine from a library is called from a source file, only
the modules that contain that routine will be linked in
with the application. This allows large libraries to be
used efficiently in many different applications.
The object linker/library features include:
• Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many
smaller files
• Enhanced code maintainability by grouping
related modules together
• Flexible creation of libraries with easy module
listing, replacement, deletion and extraction
DS41211D-page 112
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
14.7
MPLAB ICE 2000
High-Performance
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended
to provide the product development engineer with a
complete microcontroller design tool set for PIC
microcontrollers. Software control of the MPLAB ICE
2000 In-Circuit Emulator is advanced by the MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment, which allows
editing, building, downloading and source debugging
from a single environment.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 is a full-featured emulator
system with enhanced trace, trigger and data monitoring features. Interchangeable processor modules allow
the system to be easily reconfigured for emulation of
different processors. The architecture of the MPLAB
ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator allows expansion to
support new PIC microcontrollers.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft® Windows® 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
14.8
MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit
Emulator System
MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System is
Microchip’s next generation high-speed emulator for
Microchip Flash DSC® and MCU devices. It debugs and
programs PIC® and dsPIC® Flash microcontrollers with
the easy-to-use, powerful graphical user interface of the
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment (IDE),
included with each kit.
The MPLAB REAL ICE probe is connected to the design
engineer’s PC using a high-speed USB 2.0 interface and
is connected to the target with either a connector
compatible with the popular MPLAB ICD 2 system
(RJ11) or with the new high speed, noise tolerant, lowvoltage differential signal (LVDS) interconnection
(CAT5).
14.9
MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger
Microchip’s In-Circuit Debugger, MPLAB ICD 2, is a
powerful, low-cost, run-time development tool,
connecting to the host PC via an RS-232 or high-speed
USB interface. This tool is based on the Flash PIC
MCUs and can be used to develop for these and other
PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. The MPLAB ICD 2 utilizes
the in-circuit debugging capability built into the Flash
devices. This feature, along with Microchip’s In-Circuit
Serial ProgrammingTM (ICSPTM) protocol, offers costeffective, in-circuit Flash debugging from the graphical
user interface of the MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment. This enables a designer to develop and
debug source code by setting breakpoints, single stepping and watching variables, and CPU status and
peripheral registers. Running at full speed enables
testing hardware and applications in real time. MPLAB
ICD 2 also serves as a development programmer for
selected PIC devices.
14.10 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
The MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer is a universal,
CE compliant device programmer with programmable
voltage verification at VDDMIN and VDDMAX for
maximum reliability. It features a large LCD display
(128 x 64) for menus and error messages and a modular, detachable socket assembly to support various
package types. The ICSP™ cable assembly is included
as a standard item. In Stand-Alone mode, the MPLAB
PM3 Device Programmer can read, verify and program
PIC devices without a PC connection. It can also set
code protection in this mode. The MPLAB PM3
connects to the host PC via an RS-232 or USB cable.
The MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and
optimized algorithms for quick programming of large
memory devices and incorporates an SD/MMC card for
file storage and secure data applications.
MPLAB REAL ICE is field upgradeable through future
firmware downloads in MPLAB IDE. In upcoming
releases of MPLAB IDE, new devices will be supported,
and new features will be added, such as software breakpoints and assembly code trace. MPLAB REAL ICE
offers significant advantages over competitive emulators
including low-cost, full-speed emulation, real-time
variable watches, trace analysis, complex breakpoints, a
ruggedized probe interface and long (up to three meters)
interconnection cables.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 113
PIC12F683
14.11 PICSTART Plus Development
Programmer
14.13 Demonstration, Development and
Evaluation Boards
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is an
easy-to-use, low-cost, prototype programmer. It
connects to the PC via a COM (RS-232) port. MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment software makes
using the programmer simple and efficient. The
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer supports
most PIC devices in DIP packages up to 40 pins.
Larger pin count devices, such as the PIC16C92X and
PIC17C76X, may be supported with an adapter socket.
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is CE
compliant.
A wide variety of demonstration, development and
evaluation boards for various PIC MCUs and dsPIC
DSCs allows quick application development on fully functional systems. Most boards include prototyping areas for
adding custom circuitry and provide application firmware
and source code for examination and modification.
14.12 PICkit 2 Development Programmer
The PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer is a low-cost
programmer and selected Flash device debugger with
an easy-to-use interface for programming many of
Microchip’s baseline, mid-range and PIC18F families of
Flash memory microcontrollers. The PICkit 2 Starter Kit
includes a prototyping development board, twelve
sequential lessons, software and HI-TECH’s PICC™
Lite C compiler, and is designed to help get up to speed
quickly using PIC® microcontrollers. The kit provides
everything needed to program, evaluate and develop
applications using Microchip’s powerful, mid-range
Flash memory family of microcontrollers.
DS41211D-page 114
The boards support a variety of features, including LEDs,
temperature sensors, switches, speakers, RS-232
interfaces, LCD displays, potentiometers and additional
EEPROM memory.
The demonstration and development boards can be
used in teaching environments, for prototyping custom
circuits and for learning about various microcontroller
applications.
In addition to the PICDEM™ and dsPICDEM™ demonstration/development board series of circuits, Microchip
has a line of evaluation kits and demonstration software
for analog filter design, KEELOQ® security ICs, CAN,
IrDA®, PowerSmart® battery management, SEEVAL®
evaluation system, Sigma-Delta ADC, flow rate
sensing, plus many more.
Check the Microchip web page (www.microchip.com)
and the latest “Product Selector Guide” (DS00148) for
the complete list of demonstration, development and
evaluation kits.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
15.0
ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Absolute Maximum Ratings(†)
Ambient temperature under bias..........................................................................................................-40° to +125°C
Storage temperature ........................................................................................................................ -65°C to +150°C
Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ................................................................................................... -0.3V to +6.5V
Voltage on MCLR with respect to Vss ............................................................................................... -0.3V to +13.5V
Voltage on all other pins with respect to VSS ........................................................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V)
Total power dissipation(1) ............................................................................................................................... 800 mW
Maximum current out of VSS pin ...................................................................................................................... 95 mA
Maximum current into VDD pin ......................................................................................................................... 95 mA
Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD)...............................................................................................................± 20 mA
Output clamp current, IOK (Vo < 0 or Vo >VDD).........................................................................................................± 20 mA
Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin.................................................................................................... 25 mA
Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin .............................................................................................. 25 mA
Maximum current sunk by GPIO ...................................................................................................................... 90 mA
Maximum current sourced GPIO...................................................................................................................... 90 mA
Note 1:
Power dissipation is calculated as follows: PDIS = VDD x {IDD – ∑ IOH} + ∑ {(VDD – VOH) x IOH} + ∑(VOl x IOL).
† NOTICE: Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the
device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those
indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure above maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 115
PIC12F683
FIGURE 15-1:
PIC12F683 VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH,
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
5.5
5.0
VDD (V)
4.5
4.0
3.5
3.0
2.5
2.0
0
8
10
20
Frequency (MHz)
Note 1: The shaded region indicates the permissible combinations of voltage and frequency.
HFINTOSC FREQUENCY ACCURACY OVER DEVICE VDD AND TEMPERATURE
FIGURE 15-2:
125
± 5%
Temperature (°C)
85
± 2%
60
± 1%
25
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
DS41211D-page 116
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
15.1
DC Characteristics: PIC12F683-I (Industrial)
PIC12F683-E (Extended)
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
Param
No.
Min Typ† Max Units
Sym
Characteristic
Conditions
VDD
Supply Voltage
2.0
2.0
3.0
4.5
—
—
—
—
5.5
5.5
5.5
5.5
V
V
V
V
FOSC < = 8 MHz: HFINTOSC, EC
FOSC < = 4 MHz
FOSC < = 10 MHz
FOSC < = 20 MHz
D002*
VDR
RAM Data Retention
Voltage(1)
1.5
—
—
V
Device in Sleep mode
D003
VPOR
VDD Start Voltage to
ensure internal Power-on
Reset signal
—
VSS
—
V
See Section 12.3.1 “Power-on Reset”
for details.
D004*
SVDD
VDD Rise Rate to ensure
internal Power-on Reset
signal
0.05
—
—
D001
D001C
D001D
V/ms See Section 12.3.1 “Power-on Reset”
for details.
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered in Sleep mode without losing RAM data.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 117
PIC12F683
15.2
DC Characteristics: PIC12F683-I (Industrial)
PIC12F683-E (Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
D010
Conditions
Device Characteristics
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
VDD
Supply Current (IDD)
D011*
D012
D013*
D014
D015
D016*
D017
D018
D019
(1, 2)
—
11
16
μA
2.0
—
18
28
μA
3.0
—
35
54
μA
5.0
—
140
240
μA
2.0
—
220
380
μA
3.0
—
380
550
μA
5.0
—
260
360
μA
2.0
—
420
650
μA
3.0
—
0.8
1.1
mA
5.0
—
130
220
μA
2.0
—
215
360
μA
3.0
—
360
520
μA
5.0
—
220
340
μA
2.0
—
375
550
μA
3.0
—
0.65
1.0
mA
5.0
—
8
20
μA
2.0
—
16
40
μA
3.0
—
31
65
μA
5.0
—
340
450
μA
2.0
—
500
700
μA
3.0
—
0.8
1.2
mA
5.0
—
410
650
μA
2.0
—
700
950
μA
3.0
—
1.30
1.65
mA
5.0
—
230
400
μA
2.0
—
400
680
μA
3.0
—
0.63
1.1
mA
5.0
—
2.6
3.25
mA
4.5
—
2.8
3.35
mA
5.0
Note
FOSC = 32 kHz
LP Oscillator mode
FOSC = 1 MHz
XT Oscillator mode
FOSC = 4 MHz
XT Oscillator mode
FOSC = 1 MHz
EC Oscillator mode
FOSC = 4 MHz
EC Oscillator mode
FOSC = 31 kHz
LFINTOSC mode
FOSC = 4 MHz
HFINTOSC mode
FOSC = 8 MHz
HFINTOSC mode
FOSC = 4 MHz
EXTRC mode(3)
FOSC = 20 MHz
HS Oscillator mode
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are: OSC1 = external square wave,
from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD; MCLR = VDD; WDT disabled.
2: The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors, such as I/O
pin loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
3: For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can
be extended by the formula IR = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in kΩ.
DS41211D-page 118
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
15.3
DC Characteristics: PIC12F683-I (Industrial)
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
D020
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Conditions
Device Characteristics
Power-down Base
Current(IPD)(2)
D021
D022
D023
D024
D025*
D026
D027
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
VDD
Note
WDT, BOR, Comparators, VREF and
T1OSC disabled
—
0.05
1.2
μA
2.0
—
0.15
1.5
μA
3.0
—
0.35
1.8
μA
5.0
—
150
500
nA
3.0
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +25°C
—
1.0
2.2
μA
2.0
WDT Current(1)
—
2.0
4.0
μA
3.0
—
3.0
7.0
μA
5.0
—
42
60
μA
3.0
—
85
122
μA
5.0
—
32
45
μA
2.0
—
60
78
μA
3.0
—
120
160
μA
5.0
—
30
36
μA
2.0
—
45
55
μA
3.0
—
75
95
μA
5.0
—
39
47
μA
2.0
—
59
72
μA
3.0
—
98
124
μA
5.0
—
4.5
7.0
μA
2.0
—
5.0
8.0
μA
3.0
—
6.0
12
μA
5.0
—
0.30
1.6
μA
3.0
—
0.36
1.9
μA
5.0
BOR Current(1)
Comparator Current(1), both
comparators enabled
CVREF Current(1) (high range)
CVREF Current(1) (low range)
T1OSC Current(1), 32.768 kHz
A/D Current(1), no conversion in
progress
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: The peripheral current is the sum of the base IDD or IPD and the additional current consumed when this
peripheral is enabled. The peripheral Δ current can be determined by subtracting the base IDD or IPD
current from this limit. Max values should be used when calculating total current consumption.
2: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is
measured with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 119
PIC12F683
15.4
DC Characteristics: PIC12F683-E (Extended)
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
D020E
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
Conditions
Device Characteristics
Power-down Base
Current (IPD)(2)
D021E
D022E
D023E
D024E
D025E*
D026E
D027E
Min
—
Typ†
0.05
Max
9
Units
μA
VDD
Note
2.0
WDT, BOR, Comparators, VREF and
T1OSC disabled
—
0.15
11
μA
3.0
—
0.35
15
μA
5.0
—
1
17.5
μA
2.0
—
2
19
μA
3.0
—
3
22
μA
5.0
—
42
65
μA
3.0
—
85
127
μA
5.0
—
32
45
μA
2.0
—
60
78
μA
3.0
—
120
160
μA
5.0
—
30
70
μA
2.0
—
45
90
μA
3.0
—
75
120
μA
5.0
—
39
91
μA
2.0
—
59
117
μA
3.0
—
98
156
μA
5.0
—
4.5
25
μA
2.0
—
5
30
μA
3.0
—
6
40
μA
5.0
—
0.30
12
μA
3.0
—
0.36
16
μA
5.0
WDT Current(1)
BOR Current(1)
Comparator Current(1), both
comparators enabled
CVREF Current(1) (high range)
CVREF Current(1) (low range)
T1OSC Current(1), 32.768 kHz
A/D Current(1), no conversion in
progress
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: The peripheral current is the sum of the base IDD or IPD and the additional current consumed when this
peripheral is enabled. The peripheral Δ current can be determined by subtracting the base IDD or IPD
current from this limit. Max values should be used when calculating total current consumption.
2: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is
measured with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD.
DS41211D-page 120
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
15.5
DC Characteristics:
PIC12F683-I (Industrial)
PIC12F683-E (Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Sym
VIL
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Vss
Vss
Conditions
—
0.8
V
4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
—
0.15 VDD
V
2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 4.5V
Vss
—
0.2 VDD
V
2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
Input Low Voltage
I/O Port:
D030
with TTL buffer
D030A
D031
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
(1)
D032
MCLR, OSC1 (RC mode)
VSS
—
0.2 VDD
V
D033
OSC1 (XT and LP modes)
VSS
—
0.3
V
OSC1 (HS mode)
VSS
—
0.3 VDD
V
D033A
VIH
Input High Voltage
I/O ports:
D040
—
with TTL buffer
D040A
D041
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
2.0
—
VDD
V
4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
0.25 VDD + 0.8
—
VDD
V
2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 4.5V
0.8 VDD
—
VDD
V
2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
0.8 VDD
—
VDD
V
1.6
—
VDD
V
D042
MCLR
D043
OSC1 (XT and LP modes)
D043A
OSC1 (HS mode)
0.7 VDD
—
VDD
V
D043B
OSC1 (RC mode)
0.9 VDD
—
VDD
V
(Note 1)
(2)
Input Leakage Current
IIL
D060
I/O ports
—
± 0.1
±1
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
Pin at high-impedance
D061
MCLR(3)
—
± 0.1
±5
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD
D063
OSC1
—
± 0.1
±5
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD, XT, HS and
LP oscillator configuration
IPUR
GPIO Weak Pull-up Current
50
250
400
μA
VDD = 5.0V, VPIN = VSS
VOL
Output Low Voltage(5)
—
—
0.6
V
IOL = 8.5 mA, VDD = 4.5V (Ind.)
VDD – 0.7
—
—
V
IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V (Ind.)
D070*
D080
I/O ports
VOH
D090
Output High Voltage(5)
I/O ports
*
†
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are
not tested.
In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKIN pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended to use an external
clock in RC mode.
Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified levels represent
normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input voltages.
See Section 10.4.1 “Using the Data EEPROM” for additional information.
Including OSC2 in CLKOUT mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 121
PIC12F683
15.5
DC Characteristics:
PIC12F683-I (Industrial)
PIC12F683-E (Extended) (Continued)
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Sym
D100
IULP
Characteristic
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
—
200
—
nA
See Application Note AN879,
“Using the Microchip Ultra
Low-Power Wake-up Module”
(DS00879)
OSC2 pin
—
—
15
pF
In XT, HS and LP modes when
external clock is used to drive
OSC1
All I/O pins
—
—
50
pF
Ultra Low-Power Wake-Up
Current
Conditions
Capacitive Loading Specs on
Output Pins
D101*
COSC2
D101A* CIO
Data EEPROM Memory
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
D120
ED
Byte Endurance
100K
1M
—
E/W
D120A
ED
Byte Endurance
10K
100K
—
E/W
D121
VDRW
VDD for Read/Write
VMIN
—
5.5
V
D122
TDEW
Erase/Write Cycle Time
—
5
6
D123
TRETD
Characteristic Retention
40
—
—
Year Provided no other specifications
are violated
D124
TREF
Number of Total Erase/Write
Cycles before Refresh(4)
1M
10M
—
E/W
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
+85°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Using EECON1 to read/write
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
ms
Program Flash Memory
D130
EP
Cell Endurance
10K
100K
—
E/W
D130A
ED
Cell Endurance
1K
10K
—
E/W
D131
VPR
VDD for Read
VMIN
—
5.5
V
D132
VPEW
VDD for Erase/Write
4.5
—
5.5
V
D133
TPEW
Erase/Write cycle time
—
2
2.5
ms
D134
TRETD
Characteristic Retention
40
—
—
*
†
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
+85°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
Year Provided no other specifications
are violated
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are
not tested.
In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKIN pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended to use an external
clock in RC mode.
Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified levels represent
normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input voltages.
See Section 10.4.1 “Using the Data EEPROM” for additional information.
Including OSC2 in CLKOUT mode.
DS41211D-page 122
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
15.6
Thermal Considerations
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
TH01
TH02
TH03
TH04
TH05
TH06
TH07
Note 1:
2:
3:
Sym
θJA
Characteristic
Thermal Resistance
Junction to Ambient
Typ
Units
84.6
163.0
52.4
46.3
41.2
38.8
3.0
2.6
150
—
—
°C/W
°C/W
°C/W
°C/W
°C/W
°C/W
°C/W
°C/W
°C
W
W
Conditions
8-pin PDIP package
8-pin SOIC package
8-pin DFN-S 4x4x0.9 mm package
8-pin DFN-S 6x5 mm package
θJC
Thermal Resistance
8-pin PDIP package
Junction to Case
8-pin SOIC package
8-pin DFN-S 4x4x0.9 mm package
8-pin DFN-S 6x5 mm package
TJ
Junction Temperature
For derated power calculations
PD
Power Dissipation
PD = PINTERNAL + PI/O
PINTERNAL Internal Power Dissipation
PINTERNAL = IDD x VDD
(NOTE 1)
PI/O
I/O Power Dissipation
—
W
PI/O = Σ (IOL * VOL) + Σ (IOH * (VDD - VOH))
PDER
Derated Power
—
W
PDER = (TJ - TA)/θJA
(NOTE 2, 3)
IDD is current to run the chip alone without driving any load on the output pins.
TA = Ambient Temperature.
Maximum allowable power dissipation is the lower value of either the absolute maximum total power
dissipation or derated power (PDER).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 123
PIC12F683
15.7
Timing Parameter Symbology
The timing parameter symbols have been created with
one of the following formats:
1. TppS2ppS
2. TppS
T
F
Frequency
Lowercase letters (pp) and their meanings:
pp
cc
CCP1
ck
CLKOUT
cs
CS
di
SDI
do
SDO
dt
Data in
io
I/O PORT
mc
MCLR
Uppercase letters and their meanings:
S
F
Fall
H
High
I
Invalid (High-impedance)
L
Low
FIGURE 15-3:
T
Time
osc
rd
rw
sc
ss
t0
t1
wr
OSC1
RD
RD or WR
SCK
SS
T0CKI
T1CKI
WR
P
R
V
Z
Period
Rise
Valid
High-impedance
LOAD CONDITIONS
Load Condition
Pin
CL
VSS
Legend: CL =
DS41211D-page 124
50 pF
for all pins
15 pF
for OSC2 output
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
15.8
AC Characteristics: PIC12F683 (Industrial, Extended)
FIGURE 15-4:
CLOCK TIMING
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
OSC1/CLKIN
OS02
OS04
OS04
OS03
OSC2/CLKOUT
(LP,XT,HS Modes)
OSC2/CLKOUT
(CLKOUT Mode)
TABLE 15-1:
CLOCK OSCILLATOR TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
OS01
Sym
FOSC
Characteristic
External CLKIN Frequency(1)
Oscillator Frequency(1)
OS02
TOSC
External CLKIN Period(1)
Oscillator Period(1)
OS03
OS04*
TCY
TosH,
TosL
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
DC
DC
DC
DC
—
0.1
1
DC
27
250
50
50
—
250
50
250
—
—
—
—
32.768
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
30.5
—
—
—
37
4
20
20
—
4
20
4
•
•
•
•
—
10,000
1,000
—
kHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
kHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
μs
ns
ns
ns
μs
ns
ns
ns
Conditions
LP Oscillator mode
XT Oscillator mode
HS Oscillator mode
EC Oscillator mode
LP Oscillator mode
XT Oscillator mode
HS Oscillator mode
RC Oscillator mode
LP Oscillator mode
XT Oscillator mode
HS Oscillator mode
EC Oscillator mode
LP Oscillator mode
XT Oscillator mode
HS Oscillator mode
RC Oscillator mode
Instruction Cycle Time(1)
External CLKIN High,
External CLKIN Low
200
TCY
DC
ns
TCY = 4/FOSC
2
—
—
μs
LP oscillator
100
—
—
ns
XT oscillator
20
—
—
ns
HS oscillator
OS05* TosR, External CLKIN Rise,
0
—
•
ns
LP oscillator
TosF
External CLKIN Fall
0
—
•
ns
XT oscillator
0
—
•
ns
HS oscillator
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values are
based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions with the
device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or
higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at “min” values with an external
clock applied to OSC1 pin. When an external clock input is used, the “max” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock) for
all devices.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 125
PIC12F683
TABLE 15-2:
OSCILLATOR PARAMETERS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating Temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Freq.
Tolerance
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Conditions
OS06
TWARM
Internal Oscillator Switch
when running(3)
—
—
—
2
TOSC
Slowest clock
OS07
TSC
Fail-Safe Sample Clock
Period(1)
—
—
21
—
ms
LFINTOSC/64
OS08
HFOSC
Internal Calibrated
HFINTOSC Frequency(2)
OS09*
OS10*
LFOSC
Internal Uncalibrated
LFINTOSC Frequency
TIOSC
HFINTOSC Oscillator
Wake-up from Sleep
Start-up Time
ST
±1%
7.92
8.0
8.08
MHz
VDD = 3.5V, 25°C
±2%
7.84
8.0
8.16
MHz
2.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V,
0°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
±5%
7.60
8.0
8.40
MHz
2.0V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V,
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C (Ind.),
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C (Ext.)
—
15
31
45
kHz
—
5.5
12
24
μs
VDD = 2.0V, -40°C to +85°C
—
3.5
7
14
μs
VDD = 3.0V, -40°C to +85°C
—
3
6
11
μs
VDD = 5.0V, -40°C to +85°C
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only
and are not tested.
Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values are
based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions with the
device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or
higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at “min” values with an external
clock applied to the OSC1 pin. When an external clock input is used, the “max” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock)
for all devices.
2: To ensure these oscillator frequency tolerances, VDD and VSS must be capacitively decoupled as close to the
device as possible. 0.1 μF and 0.01 μF values in parallel are recommended.
3: By design.
DS41211D-page 126
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 15-5:
CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING
Cycle
Write
Fetch
Read
Execute
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Fosc
OS12
OS11
OS20
OS21
CLKOUT
OS19
OS18
OS16
OS13
OS17
I/O pin
(Input)
OS14
OS15
I/O pin
(Output)
New Value
Old Value
OS18, OS19
TABLE 15-3:
CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING PARAMETERS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristic
TOSH2CKL
FOSC↑ to CLKOUT↓ (1)
OS12
TOSH2CKH
FOSC↑ to CLKOUT↑
(1)
OS13
TCKL2IOV
CLKOUT↓ to Port out valid(1)
OS14
TIOV2CKH
Port input valid before CLKOUT↑(1)
OS15*
TOSH2IOV
OS16
OS11
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Conditions
—
—
70
ns
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 5.0V
—
—
72
ns
—
—
20
ns
TOSC + 200 ns
—
—
ns
FOSC↑ (Q1 cycle) to Port out valid
—
50
70
ns
VDD = 5.0V
TOSH2IOI
FOSC↑ (Q2 cycle) to Port input invalid
(I/O in hold time)
50
—
—
ns
VDD = 5.0V
OS17
TIOV2OSH
Port input valid to FOSC↑ (Q2 cycle)
(I/O in setup time)
20
—
—
ns
OS18
TIOR
Port output rise time(2)
—
—
15
40
72
32
ns
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 5.0V
OS19
TIOF
Port output fall time(2)
—
—
28
15
55
30
ns
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 5.0V
OS20*
TINP
INT pin input high or low time
25
—
—
ns
OS21*
TGPP
GPIO interrupt-on-change new input
level time
TCY
—
—
ns
*
†
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
Measurements are taken in RC mode where CLKOUT output is 4 x TOSC.
Includes OSC2 in CLKOUT mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 127
PIC12F683
FIGURE 15-6:
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND
POWER-UP TIMER TIMING
VDD
MCLR
30
Internal
POR
33
PWRT
Time-out
32
OSC
Start-Up Time
Internal Reset(1)
Watchdog Timer
Reset(1)
31
34
34
I/O pins
Note 1:
Asserted low.
FIGURE 15-7:
BROWN-OUT RESET TIMING AND CHARACTERISTICS
VDD
VBOR + VHYST
VBOR
(Device in Brown-out Reset)
(Device not in Brown-out Reset)
37
Reset
(due to BOR)
*
33*
64 ms delay only if PWRTE bit in the Configuration Word register is programmed to ‘0’.
DS41211D-page 128
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
TABLE 15-4:
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER
AND BROWN-OUT RESET PARAMETERS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Conditions
30
TMCL
MCLR Pulse Width (low)
2
5
—
—
—
—
μs
μs
VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C
VDD = 5V
31
TWDT
Watchdog Timer Time-out
Period (No Prescaler)
10
10
16
16
29
31
ms
ms
VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C
VDD = 5V
32
TOST
Oscillation Start-up Timer
Period(1, 2)
—
1024
—
33*
TPWRT
Power-up Timer Period
40
65
140
ms
34*
TIOZ
I/O High-impedance from
MCLR Low or Watchdog Timer
Reset
—
—
2.0
μs
35
VBOR
Brown-out Reset Voltage
2.0
—
2.2
V
36*
VHYST
Brown-out Reset Hysteresis
—
50
—
mV
37*
TBOR
Brown-out Reset Minimum
Detection Period
100
—
—
μs
TOSC (NOTE 3)
(NOTE 4)
VDD ≤ VBOR
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values
are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions
with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at “min” values
with an external clock applied to the OSC1 pin. When an external clock input is used, the “max” cycle time
limit is “DC” (no clock) for all devices.
2: By design.
3: Period of the slower clock.
4: To ensure these voltage tolerances, VDD and VSS must be capacitively decoupled as close to the device as
possible. 0.1 μF and 0.01 μF values in parallel are recommended.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 129
PIC12F683
FIGURE 15-8:
TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMINGS
T0CKI
40
41
42
T1CKI
45
46
49
47
TMR0 or
TMR1
TABLE 15-5:
TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating Temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
40*
Sym
TT0H
Characteristic
T0CKI High Pulse Width
No Prescaler
With Prescaler
41*
TT0L
T0CKI Low Pulse Width
No Prescaler
42*
TT0P
T0CKI Period
45*
TT1H
T1CKI High Synchronous, No Prescaler
Time
Synchronous,
with Prescaler
With Prescaler
Asynchronous
46*
TT1L
T1CKI Low
Time
Synchronous, No Prescaler
Synchronous,
with Prescaler
Asynchronous
47*
TT1P
T1CKI Input Synchronous
Period
48
FT1
Timer1 Oscillator Input Frequency Range
(oscillator enabled by setting bit T1OSCEN)
49*
TCKEZTMR1 Delay from External Clock Edge to Timer
Increment
Asynchronous
*
†
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
10
—
—
ns
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
10
—
—
ns
Greater of:
20 or TCY + 40
N
—
—
ns
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
15
—
—
ns
30
—
—
ns
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
15
—
—
ns
30
—
—
ns
Greater of:
30 or TCY + 40
N
—
—
ns
60
—
—
ns
—
32.768
—
kHz
2 TOSC
—
7 TOSC
—
Conditions
N = prescale value
(2, 4, ..., 256)
N = prescale value
(1, 2, 4, 8)
Timers in Sync
mode
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not
tested.
DS41211D-page 130
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 15-9:
CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM TIMINGS (ECCP)
CCP1
(Capture mode)
CC01
CC02
CC03
Note:
TABLE 15-6:
Refer to Figure 15-3 for load conditions.
CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM REQUIREMENTS (ECCP)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
CC01*
CC02*
CC03*
Sym
TccL
TccH
TccP
Characteristic
CCP1 Input Low Time
CCP1 Input High Time
CCP1 Input Period
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
No Prescaler
0.5TCY + 20
—
—
ns
With Prescaler
20
—
—
ns
No Prescaler
0.5TCY + 20
—
—
ns
With Prescaler
20
—
—
ns
3TCY + 40
N
—
—
ns
Conditions
N = prescale
value (1, 4 or
16)
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 131
PIC12F683
TABLE 15-7:
COMPARATOR SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating Temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristics
CM01
VOS
Input Offset Voltage
CM02
VCM
Input Common Mode Voltage
CM03* CMRR
Common Mode Rejection Ratio
CM04* TRT
Response Time
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
—
± 5.0
± 10
mV
0
—
VDD – 1.5
V
+55
—
—
dB
Falling
—
150
600
ns
Rising
—
200
1000
ns
—
—
10
μs
CM05* TMC2COV Comparator Mode Change to
Output Valid
Comments
(VDD - 1.5)/2
(NOTE 1)
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: Response time is measured with one comparator input at (VDD - 1.5)/2 - 100 mV to (VDD - 1.5)/2 + 20 mV.
TABLE 15-8:
COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE (CVREF) SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristics
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Comments
CV01*
CLSB
Step Size(2)
—
—
VDD/24
VDD/32
—
—
V
V
Low Range (VRR = 1)
High Range (VRR = 0)
CV02*
CACC
Absolute Accuracy
—
—
—
—
± 1/2
± 1/2
LSb
LSb
Low Range (VRR = 1)
High Range (VRR = 0)
CV03*
CR
Unit Resistor Value (R)
—
2k
—
Ω
CV04*
CST
Settling Time(1)
—
—
10
μs
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design
guidance only and are not tested.
Note 1: Settling time measured while VRR = 1 and VR<3:0> transitions from ‘0000’ to ‘1111’.
2: See Section 8.11 “Comparator Voltage Reference” for more information.
DS41211D-page 132
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
TABLE 15-9:
PIC12F683 A/D CONVERTER (ADC) CHARACTERISTICS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
Sym
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Conditions
AD01
NR
Resolution
—
—
10 bits
AD02
EIL
Integral Error
—
—
±1
LSb VREF = 5.12V
AD03
EDL
Differential Error
—
—
±1
LSb No missing codes to 10 bits
VREF = 5.12V
AD04
EOFF
Offset Error
—
—
±1
LSb VREF = 5.12V
AD07
EGN
LSb VREF = 5.12V
bit
Gain Error
—
—
±1
AD06 VREF
AD06A
Reference Voltage(3)
2.2
2.7
—
—
VDD
V
AD07
VAIN
Full-Scale Range
VSS
—
VREF
V
AD08
ZAIN
Recommended
Impedance of Analog
Voltage Source
—
—
10
kΩ
AD09* IREF
VREF Input Current(3)
10
—
1000
μA
During VAIN acquisition.
Based on differential of VHOLD to VAIN.
—
—
50
μA
During A/D conversion cycle.
Absolute minimum to ensure 1 LSb
accuracy
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: Total Absolute Error includes integral, differential, offset and gain errors.
2: The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage and has no missing
codes.
3: ADC VREF is from external VREF or VDD pin, whichever is selected as reference input.
4: When ADC is off, it will not consume any current other than leakage current. The power-down current
specification includes any such leakage from the ADC module.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 133
PIC12F683
TABLE 15-10: PIC12F683 A/D CONVERSION REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
Param
No.
Sym
AD130* TAD
Characteristic
A/D Clock Period
A/D Internal RC
Oscillator Period
AD131 TCNV
Conversion Time
(not including
Acquisition Time)(1)
Min
Typ†
1.6
—
9.0
μs
TOSC-based, VREF ≥ 3.0V
3.0
—
9.0
μs
TOSC-based, VREF full range
3.0
6.0
9.0
μs
ADCS<1:0> = 11 (ADRC mode)
At VDD = 2.5V
1.6
4.0
6.0
μs
At VDD = 5.0V
—
11
—
TAD
Set GO/DONE bit to new data in A/D
Result register.
11.5
—
μs
Amplifier Settling Time
—
—
5
μs
Q4 to A/D Clock Start
—
TOSC/2
—
—
—
TOSC/2 + TCY
—
—
AD132* TACQ Acquisition Time
AD133*
TAMP
AD134 TGO
Max Units
Conditions
If the A/D clock source is selected as
RC, a time of TCY is added before the
A/D clock starts. This allows the SLEEP
instruction to be executed.
* These parameters are characterized but not tested.
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: ADRESH and ADRESL registers may be read on the following TCY cycle.
2: See Section 9.3 “A/D Acquisition Requirements” for minimum conditions.
DS41211D-page 134
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 15-10:
PIC12F683 A/D CONVERSION TIMING (NORMAL MODE)
BSF ADCON0, GO
AD134
1 TCY
(TOSC/2(1))
AD131
Q4
AD130
A/D CLK
9
A/D Data
8
7
6
3
2
1
0
NEW_DATA
OLD_DATA
ADRES
1 TCY
ADIF
GO
DONE
Note 1:
Sampling Stopped
AD132
Sample
If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This allows the
SLEEP instruction to be executed.
FIGURE 15-11:
PIC12F683 A/D CONVERSION TIMING (SLEEP MODE)
BSF ADCON0, GO
AD134
(TOSC/2 + TCY(1))
1 TCY
AD131
Q4
AD130
A/D CLK
9
A/D Data
8
7
6
OLD_DATA
ADRES
3
2
1
0
NEW_DATA
ADIF
1 TCY
GO
DONE
Sample
Note 1:
AD132
Sampling Stopped
If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This allows the
SLEEP instruction to be executed.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 135
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 136
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
16.0
DC AND AC CHARACTERISTICS GRAPHS AND TABLES
The graphs and tables provided in this section are for design guidance and are not tested.
In some graphs or tables, the data presented are outside specified operating range (i.e., outside specified VDD
range). This is for information only and devices are ensured to operate properly only within the specified range.
Note:
The graphs and tables provided following this note are a statistical summary based on a limited number of
samples and are provided for informational purposes only. The performance characteristics listed herein are
not tested or guaranteed. In some graphs or tables, the data presented may be outside the specified
operating range (e.g., outside specified power supply range) and therefore, outside the warranted range.
“Typical” represents the mean of the distribution at 25°C. “Maximum” or “minimum” represents
(mean + 3σ) or (mean - 3σ) respectively, where σ is a standard deviation, over each temperature range.
FIGURE 16-1:
TYPICAL IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (EC MODE)
3.5
3.0
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
5.5V
5.0V
IDD (mA)
2.5
2.0
4.0V
1.5
3.0V
1.0
2.0V
0.5
0.0
1 MHz
2 MHz
4 MHz
6 MHz
8 MHz
10 MHz
12 MHz
14 MHz
16 MHz
18 MHz
20 MHz
FOSC
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 137
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-2:
MAXIMUM IDD vs. FOSC OVER
VDD (EC MODE)
EC Mode
4.0
3.5
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
5.5V
5.0V
3.0
IDD (mA)
2.5
4.0V
2.0
3.0V
1.5
2.0V
1.0
0.5
0.0
1 MHz
2 MHz
4 MHz
6 MHz
8 MHz
10 MHz
12 MHz
14 MHz
16 MHz
18 MHz
20 MHz
FOSC
FIGURE 16-3:
TYPICAL IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (HS MODE)
Typical IDD vs. FOSC Over Vdd
HS Mode
4.0
3.5
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
5.5V
3.0
5.0V
IDD (mA)
2.5
4.5V
2.0
1.5
4.0V
3.5V
3.0V
1.0
0.5
0.0
4 MHz
10 MHz
16 MHz
20 MHz
FOSC
DS41211D-page 138
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-4:
MAXIMUM IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (HS MODE)
Maximum IDD vs. FOSC Over Vdd
HS Mode
5.0
4.5
4.0
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
5.5V
IDD (mA)
3.5
5.0V
3.0
4.5V
2.5
2.0
1.5
4.0V
3.5V
3.0V
1.0
0.5
0.0
4 MHz
10 MHz
16 MHz
20 MHz
FOSC
FIGURE 16-5:
TYPICAL IDD vs. VDD OVER FOSC (XT MODE)
XT Mode
900
800
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
700
IDD (μA)
600
500
4 MHz
400
300
1 MHz
200
100
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 139
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-6:
MAXIMUM IDD vs. VDD OVER FOSC (XT MODE)
XT Mode
1,400
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
1,200
IDD (μA)
1,000
800
4 MHz
600
400
1 MHz
200
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-7:
TYPICAL IDD vs. VDD OVER
FOSC (EXTRC MODE)
EXTRC Mode
800
700
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
600
IDD (μA)
500
4 MHz
400
300
1 MHz
200
100
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
VDD (V)
DS41211D-page 140
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-8:
MAXIMUM IDD vs. VDD (EXTRC MODE)
EXTRC Mode
1,400
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
1,200
IDD (μA)
1,000
4 MHz
800
600
1 MHz
400
200
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-9:
IDD vs. VDD OVER FOSC (LFINTOSC MODE, 31 kHz)
LFINTOSC Mode, 31KHZ
80
70
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
60
IDD (μA)
50
Maximum
40
30
Typical
20
10
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
VDD (V)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 141
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-10:
IDD vs. VDD (LP MODE)
LP Mode
70
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
60
50
IDD (μA)
32 kHz Maximum
40
30
32 kHz Typical
20
10
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-11:
TYPICAL IDD vs. FOSC OVER
VDD (HFINTOSC MODE)
HFINTOSC
1,600
1,400
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
5.5V
5.0V
1,200
IDD (μA)
1,000
4.0V
800
3.0V
600
2.0V
400
200
0
125 kHz
250 kHz
500 kHz
1 MHz
2 MHz
4 MHz
8 MHz
FOSC
DS41211D-page 142
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-12:
MAXIMUM IDD vs. FOSC OVER VDD (HFINTOSC MODE)
HFINTOSC
2,000
1,800
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
5.5V
5.0V
1,600
1,400
4.0V
IDD (μA)
1,200
1,000
3.0V
800
600
2.0V
400
200
0
125 kHz
250 kHz
500 kHz
1 MHz
2 MHz
4 MHz
8 MHz
FOSC
FIGURE 16-13:
TYPICAL IPD vs. VDD (SLEEP MODE, ALL PERIPHERALS DISABLED)
Typical
(Sleep Mode all Peripherals Disabled)
0.45
0.40
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
0.35
IPD (μA)
0.30
0.25
0.20
0.15
0.10
0.05
0.0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 143
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-14:
MAXIMUM IPD vs. VDD (SLEEP MODE, ALL PERIPHERALS DISABLED)
Maximum
(Sleep Mode all Peripherals Disabled)
18.0
16.0
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum:
Mean +
3σ
Maximum: Mean
(Worst-case
Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
14.0
Max. 125°C
IPD (μA)
12.0
10.0
8.0
6.0
4.0
Max. 85°C
2.0
0.0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-15:
COMPARATOR IPD vs. VDD (BOTH COMPARATORS ENABLED)
180
160
140
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
IPD (μA)
120
Maximum
100
Typical
80
60
40
20
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
DS41211D-page 144
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-16:
BOR IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
160
140
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
120
IPD (μA)
100
Maximum
80
Typical
60
40
20
0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-17:
TYPICAL WDT IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
Typical
3.0
2.5
Typical: Statistical
StatisticalMean
Mean @25°C
@25°C
Typical:
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
IPD (μA)
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 145
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-18:
MAXIMUM WDT IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
Maximum
25.0
20.0
IPD (μA)
Max. 125°C
15.0
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
10.0
Max. 85°C
5.0
0.0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-19:
WDT PERIOD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
30
28
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
Max. (125°C)
26
Max. (85°C)
24
Time (ms)
22
20
Typical
18
16
14
Minimum
12
10
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
DS41211D-page 146
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-20:
WDT PERIOD vs. TEMPERATURE OVER VDD (5.0V)
Vdd = 5V
30
28
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
26
Maximum
24
Time (ms)
22
20
Typical
18
16
Minimum
14
12
10
-40°C
25°C
85°C
125°C
Temperature (°C)
FIGURE 16-21:
CVREF IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (HIGH RANGE)
High Range
140
120
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
100
IPD (μA)
Max. 125°C
80
Max. 85°C
60
Typical
40
20
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 147
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-22:
CVREF IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (LOW RANGE)
180
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
160
140
120
IPD (μA)
Max. 125°C
100
Max. 85°C
80
Typical
60
40
20
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-23:
VOL vs. IOL OVER TEMPERATURE (VDD = 3.0V)
(VDD = 3V, -40×C TO 125×C)
0.8
0.7
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
Max. 125°C
0.6
VOL (V)
0.5
Max. 85°C
0.4
Typical 25°C
0.3
0.2
Min. -40°C
0.1
0.0
5.0
5.5
6.0
6.5
7.0
7.5
8.0
8.5
9.0
9.5
10.0
IOL (mA)
DS41211D-page 148
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-24:
VOL vs. IOL OVER TEMPERATURE (VDD = 5.0V)
0.45
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Typical:
Statistical
Mean Temp)
@25×C+ 3σ
Maximum:
Mean
(Worst-case
Maximum: Means
(-40×C
+ 3 to 125×C)
(-40°C to 125°C)
0.40
Max. 125°C
0.35
Max. 85°C
VOL (V)
0.30
0.25
Typ. 25°C
0.20
0.15
Min. -40°C
0.10
0.05
0.00
5.0
5.5
6.0
6.5
7.0
7.5
8.0
8.5
9.0
9.5
10.0
IOL (mA)
FIGURE 16-25:
VOH vs. IOH OVER TEMPERATURE (VDD = 3.0V)
3.5
3.0
Max. -40°C
Typ. 25°C
2.5
Min. 125°C
VOH (V)
2.0
1.5
1.0
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
0.5
0.0
0.0
-0.5
-1.0
-1.5
-2.0
-2.5
-3.0
-3.5
-4.0
IOH (mA)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 149
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-26:
VOH vs. IOH OVER TEMPERATURE
(VDD
= 5.0V)
(VDD = 5V, -40×C TO
125×C)
5.5
5.0
Max. -40°C
Typ. 25°C
VOH (V)
4.5
Min. 125°C
4.0
3.5
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
3.0
0.0
-0.5
-1.0
-1.5
-2.0
-2.5
-3.0
-3.5
-4.0
-4.5
-5.0
IOH (mA)
FIGURE 16-27:
TTL INPUT THRESHOLD VIN vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
(TTL Input, -40×C TO 125×C)
1.7
1.5
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
Max. -40°C
VIN (V)
1.3
Typ. 25°C
1.1
Min. 125°C
0.9
0.7
0.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
DS41211D-page 150
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-28:
SCHMITT TRIGGER INPUT THRESHOLD VIN vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
(ST Input, -40×C TO 125×C)
4.0
VIH Max. 125°C
3.5
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
VIH Min. -40°C
VIN (V)
3.0
2.5
2.0
VIL Max. -40°C
1.5
VIL Min. 125°C
1.0
0.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-29:
T1OSC IPD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (32 kHz)
45.0
40.0
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean
Mean
(Worst-case
Temp) + 3σ
Maximum:
(-40×C
+
3 to 125×C)
(-40°C to 125°C)
35.0
Max. 125°C
IPD (mA)
30.0
25.0
20.0
15.0
Max. 85°C
10.0
5.0
Typ. 25°C
0.0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 151
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-30:
COMPARATOR RESPONSE TIME (RISING EDGE)
531
806
1000
900
Max. 125°C
Response Time (nS)
800
700
600
Note:
500
VCM = VDD - 1.5V)/2
V+ input = VCM
V- input = Transition from VCM + 100MV to VCM - 20MV
Max. 85°C
400
300
Typ. 25°C
200
Min. -40°C
100
0
2.0
2.5
4.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-31:
COMPARATOR RESPONSE TIME (FALLING EDGE)
1000
900
Max. 125°C
800
Response Time (nS)
700
600
Note:
500
VCM = VDD - 1.5V)/2
V+ input = VCM
V- input = Transition from VCM - 100MV to VCM + 20MV
Max. 85°C
400
300
Typ. 25°C
200
Min. -40°C
100
0
2.0
2.5
4.0
5.5
VDD (V)
DS41211D-page 152
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-32:
LFINTOSC FREQUENCY vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE (31 kHz)
LFINTOSC 31Khz
45,000
40,000
Max. -40°C
35,000
Typ. 25°C
Frequency (Hz)
30,000
25,000
20,000
Min. 85°C
Min. 125°C
15,000
10,000
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
5,000
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-33:
ADC CLOCK PERIOD vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
8
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
125°C
6
Time (μs)
85°C
4
25°C
-40°C
2
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 153
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-34:
TYPICAL HFINTOSC START-UP TIMES vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
16
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
14
85°C
12
25°C
Time (μs)
10
-40°C
8
6
4
2
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-35:
MAXIMUM HFINTOSC START-UP TIMES vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
-40C to +85C
25
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
Time (μs)
20
15
85°C
25°C
10
-40°C
5
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
DS41211D-page 154
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-36:
MINIMUM HFINTOSC START-UP TIMES vs. VDD OVER TEMPERATURE
-40C to +85C
10
9
Typical: Statistical Mean @25°C
Maximum: Mean (Worst-case Temp) + 3σ
(-40°C to 125°C)
8
7
Time (μs)
85°C
6
25°C
5
-40°C
4
3
2
1
0
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-37:
TYPICAL HFINTOSC FREQUENCY CHANGE vs. VDD (25°C)
5
4
Change from Calibration (%)
3
2
1
0
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 155
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-38:
TYPICAL HFINTOSC FREQUENCY CHANGE OVER DEVICE VDD (85°C)
5
4
Change from Calibration (%)
3
2
1
0
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
FIGURE 16-39:
TYPICAL HFINTOSC FREQUENCY CHANGE vs. VDD (125°C)
5
4
Change from Calibration (%)
3
2
1
0
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
DS41211D-page 156
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
FIGURE 16-40:
TYPICAL HFINTOSC FREQUENCY CHANGE vs. VDD (-40°C)
5
4
Change from Calibration (%)
3
2
1
0
-1
-2
-3
-4
-5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
VDD (V)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 157
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 158
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
17.0
PACKAGING INFORMATION
17.1
Package Marking Information
8-Lead PDIP
Example
12F683
I/P e3 017
0415
XXXXXXXX
XXXXXNNN
YYWW
8-Lead SOIC (3.90 mm)
12F683 e3
I/SN0415
017
XXXXXXXX
XXXXYYWW
NNN
8-Lead DFN (4x4x0.9 mm)
XXXXXX
XXXXXX
YYWW
NNN
Legend: XX...X
Y
YY
WW
NNN
e3
*
Note:
*
Example
12F683
I/MD e3
0415
017
8-Lead DFN-S (6x5 mm)
XXXXXXX
XXXXXXX
XXYYWW
NNN
Example
Example
12F683
I/MF e3
0415
017
Customer-specific information
Year code (last digit of calendar year)
Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year)
Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’)
Alphanumeric traceability code
Pb-free JEDEC designator for Matte Tin (Sn)
This package is Pb-free. The Pb-free JEDEC designator ( e3 )
can be found on the outer packaging for this package.
In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will
be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available
characters for customer-specific information.
Standard PIC® device marking consists of Microchip part number, year code, week code and traceability
code. For PIC device marking beyond this, certain price adders apply. Please check with your Microchip
Sales Office. For QTP devices, any special marking adders are included in QTP price.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 159
PIC12F683
17.2
Package Details
The following sections give the technical details of the packages.
8-Lead Plastic Dual In-Line (P or PA) – 300 mil Body [PDIP]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
N
NOTE 1
E1
1
3
2
D
E
A2
A
L
A1
c
e
eB
b1
b
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
INCHES
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
8
Pitch
e
Top to Seating Plane
A
–
–
.210
Molded Package Thickness
A2
.115
.130
.195
Base to Seating Plane
A1
.015
–
–
Shoulder to Shoulder Width
E
.290
.310
.325
Molded Package Width
E1
.240
.250
.280
Overall Length
D
.348
.365
.400
Tip to Seating Plane
L
.115
.130
.150
Lead Thickness
c
.008
.010
.015
b1
.040
.060
.070
b
.014
.018
.022
eB
–
–
Upper Lead Width
Lower Lead Width
Overall Row Spacing §
.100 BSC
.430
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located with the hatched area.
2. § Significant Characteristic.
3. Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed .010" per side.
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-018B
DS41211D-page 160
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
8-Lead Plastic Small Outline (SN or OA) – Narrow, 3.90 mm Body [SOIC]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D
e
N
E
E1
NOTE 1
1
2
3
α
h
b
h
A2
A
c
φ
L
A1
L1
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
β
MILLIMETERS
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
8
Pitch
e
Overall Height
A
–
1.27 BSC
–
Molded Package Thickness
A2
1.25
–
–
Standoff §
A1
0.10
–
0.25
Overall Width
E
Molded Package Width
E1
3.90 BSC
Overall Length
D
4.90 BSC
1.75
6.00 BSC
Chamfer (optional)
h
0.25
–
0.50
Foot Length
L
0.40
–
1.27
Footprint
L1
1.04 REF
Foot Angle
φ
0°
–
8°
Lead Thickness
c
0.17
–
0.25
Lead Width
b
0.31
–
0.51
Mold Draft Angle Top
α
5°
–
15°
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
β
5°
–
15°
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. § Significant Characteristic.
3. Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.15 mm per side.
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-057B
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 161
PIC12F683
8-Lead Plastic Dual Flat, No Lead Package (MD) – 4x4x0.9 mm Body [DFN]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D
e
b
N
N
L
E
E2
K
EXPOSED
PAD
1
2
2
1
NOTE 1
NOTE 1
D2
TOP VIEW
BOTTOM VIEW
A3
A
A1
NOTE 2
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
MILLIMETERS
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
8
Pitch
e
Overall Height
A
0.80
0.90
1.00
Standoff
A1
0.00
0.02
0.05
Contact Thickness
A3
Overall Length
D
Exposed Pad Width
E2
Overall Width
E
Exposed Pad Length
0.80 BSC
0.20 REF
4.00 BSC
0.00
2.20
2.80
4.00 BSC
D2
0.00
3.00
Contact Width
b
0.25
0.30
0.35
Contact Length
L
0.30
0.55
0.65
Contact-to-Exposed Pad
K
0.20
–
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. Package may have one or more exposed tie bars at ends.
3. Package is saw singulated.
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
3.60
–
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-131C
DS41211D-page 162
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
8-Lead Plastic Dual Flat, No Lead Package (MF) – 6x5 mm Body [DFN-S]
PUNCH SINGULATED
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D
D1
e
b
N
L
N
K
E
E2
E1
EXPOSED
PAD
NOTE 1
2
2
1
1
NOTE 1
D2
TOP VIEW
BOTTOM VIEW
φ
A2
A
A1
A3
NOTE 2
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
MILLIMETERS
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
8
Pitch
e
Overall Height
A
–
1.27 BSC
0.85
Molded Package Thickness
A2
–
0.65
0.80
Standoff
A1
0.00
0.01
0.05
Base Thickness
A3
0.20 REF
Overall Length
D
4.92 BSC
Molded Package Length
D1
Exposed Pad Length
D2
Overall Width
E
Molded Package Width
E1
Exposed Pad Width
E2
2.16
2.31
Contact Width
b
0.35
0.40
0.47
Contact Length
L
0.50
0.60
0.75
Contact-to-Exposed Pad
K
0.20
–
–
Model Draft Angle Top
φ
–
–
12°
1.00
4.67 BSC
3.85
4.00
4.15
5.99 BSC
5.74 BSC
2.46
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. Package may have one or more exposed tie bars at ends.
3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-113B
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 163
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 164
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
APPENDIX A:
DATA SHEET
REVISION HISTORY
Revision A
APPENDIX B:
MIGRATING FROM
OTHER PIC®
DEVICES
This is a new data sheet.
This discusses some of the issues in migrating from
other PIC devices to the PIC12F683 device.
Revision B
B.1
Rewrites of the Oscillator and Special Features of the
CPU sections. General corrections to Figures and
formatting.
TABLE B-1:
Revision C
Revisions throughout document. Incorporated Golden
Chapters.
Revision D
Replaced Package Drawings; Revised Product ID
Section (SN package to 3.90 mm); Replaced PICmicro
with PIC; Replaced Dev Tool Section.
PIC16F676 to PIC12F683
FEATURE COMPARISON
Feature
Max Operating
Speed
Max Program
Memory (Words)
PIC12F683
20 MHz
20 MHz
1024
2048
SRAM (bytes)
64
128
A/D Resolution
10-bit
10-bit
Data EEPROM
(Bytes)
128
256
Timers (8/16-bit)
1/1
2/1
Oscillator Modes
8
8
Brown-out Reset
Y
Y
Internal Pull-ups
RA0/1/2/4/5
GP0/1/2/4/5,
MCLR
Interrupt-on-change
RA0/1/2/3/4/5 GP0/1/2/3/4/5
Comparator
1
1
ECCP
N
N
Ultra Low-Power
Wake-Up
N
Y
Extended WDT
N
Y
Software Control
Option of WDT/BOR
N
Y
4 MHz
32 kHz8 MHz
N
Y
INTOSC
Frequencies
Clock Switching
Note:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC16F676
This device has been designed to perform
to the parameters of its data sheet. It has
been tested to an electrical specification
designed to determine its conformance
with these parameters. Due to process
differences in the manufacture of this
device, this device may have different
performance characteristics than its earlier
version. These differences may cause this
device to perform differently in your
application than the earlier version of this
device.
DS41211D-page 165
PIC12F683
NOTES:
DS41211D-page 166
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
INDEX
A
A/D
Specifications.................................................... 133, 134
Absolute Maximum Ratings .............................................. 115
AC Characteristics
Industrial and Extended ............................................ 125
Load Conditions ........................................................ 124
ADC .................................................................................... 61
Acquisition Requirements ........................................... 67
Associated registers.................................................... 69
Block Diagram............................................................. 61
Calculating Acquisition Time....................................... 67
Channel Selection....................................................... 61
Configuration............................................................... 61
Configuring Interrupt ................................................... 64
Conversion Clock........................................................ 62
Conversion Procedure ................................................ 64
GPIO Configuration..................................................... 61
Internal Sampling Switch (RSS) IMPEDANCE ................ 67
Interrupts..................................................................... 63
Operation .................................................................... 63
Operation During Sleep .............................................. 64
Reference Voltage (VREF)........................................... 62
Result Formatting........................................................ 63
Source Impedance...................................................... 67
Special Event Trigger.................................................. 64
Starting an A/D Conversion ........................................ 63
ADCON0 Register............................................................... 65
ADRESH Register (ADFM = 0) ........................................... 66
ADRESH Register (ADFM = 1) ........................................... 66
ADRESL Register (ADFM = 0)............................................ 66
ADRESL Register (ADFM = 1)............................................ 66
Analog Input Connection Considerations............................ 52
Analog-to-Digital Converter. See ADC
ANSEL Register .................................................................. 33
Assembler
MPASM Assembler................................................... 112
B
Block Diagrams
(CCP) Capture Mode Operation ................................. 76
ADC ............................................................................ 61
ADC Transfer Function ............................................... 68
Analog Input Model ............................................... 52, 68
CCP PWM................................................................... 78
Clock Source............................................................... 19
Comparator ................................................................. 51
Compare ..................................................................... 77
Crystal Operation ........................................................ 22
External RC Mode....................................................... 23
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) ................................. 29
GP1 Pin....................................................................... 37
GP2 Pin....................................................................... 37
GP3 Pin....................................................................... 38
GP4 Pin....................................................................... 38
GP5 Pin....................................................................... 39
In-Circuit Serial Programming Connections.............. 100
Interrupt Logic ............................................................. 93
MCLR Circuit............................................................... 86
On-Chip Reset Circuit ................................................. 85
PIC12F683.................................................................... 5
Resonator Operation................................................... 22
Timer1......................................................................... 44
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Timer2 ........................................................................ 49
TMR0/WDT Prescaler ................................................ 41
Watchdog Timer (WDT).............................................. 96
Brown-out Reset (BOR)...................................................... 87
Associated .................................................................. 88
Calibration .................................................................. 87
Specifications ........................................................... 129
Timing and Characteristics ....................................... 128
C
C Compilers
MPLAB C18.............................................................. 112
MPLAB C30.............................................................. 112
Calibration Bits.................................................................... 85
Capture Module. See Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP)
Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) .......................................... 75
Associated registers w/ Capture, Compare
and Timer1 ......................................................... 81
Associated registers w/ PWM and Timer2.................. 81
Capture Mode............................................................. 76
CCPx Pin Configuration.............................................. 76
Compare Mode........................................................... 77
CCPx Pin Configuration...................................... 77
Software Interrupt Mode ............................... 76, 77
Special Event Trigger ......................................... 77
Timer1 Mode Selection................................. 76, 77
Prescaler .................................................................... 76
PWM Mode................................................................. 78
Duty Cycle .......................................................... 79
Effects of Reset .................................................. 80
Example PWM Frequencies and
Resolutions, 20 MHZ .................................. 79
Example PWM Frequencies and
Resolutions, 8 MHz .................................... 79
Operation in Sleep Mode.................................... 80
Setup for Operation ............................................ 80
System Clock Frequency Changes .................... 80
PWM Period ............................................................... 79
Setup for PWM Operation .......................................... 80
Timer Resources ........................................................ 75
CCP. See Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP)
CCP1CON Register............................................................ 75
Clock Sources
External Modes........................................................... 21
EC ...................................................................... 21
HS ...................................................................... 22
LP ....................................................................... 22
OST .................................................................... 21
RC ...................................................................... 23
XT ....................................................................... 22
Internal Modes............................................................ 23
Frequency Selection........................................... 25
HFINTOSC ......................................................... 23
INTOSC .............................................................. 23
INTOSCIO .......................................................... 23
LFINTOSC.......................................................... 25
Clock Switching .................................................................. 27
Code Examples
A/D Conversion .......................................................... 64
Assigning Prescaler to Timer0.................................... 42
Assigning Prescaler to WDT....................................... 42
Changing Between Capture Prescalers ..................... 76
Data EEPROM Read.................................................. 73
Data EEPROM Write .................................................. 73
DS41211D-page 167
PIC12F683
Indirect Addressing ..................................................... 18
Initializing GPIO .......................................................... 31
Saving STATUS and W Registers in RAM ................. 95
Ultra Low-Power Wake-up Initialization ...................... 35
Write Verify ................................................................. 73
Code Protection .................................................................. 99
Comparator ......................................................................... 51
C2OUT as T1 Gate ..................................................... 57
Configurations ............................................................. 53
I/O Operating Modes................................................... 53
Interrupts ..................................................................... 55
Operation .............................................................. 51, 54
Operation During Sleep .............................................. 56
Response Time ........................................................... 54
Synchronizing COUT w/Timer1 .................................. 57
Comparator Module
Associated registers.................................................... 59
Comparator Voltage Reference (CVREF)
Response Time ........................................................... 54
Comparator Voltage Reference (CVREF) ............................ 58
Effects of a Reset........................................................ 56
Specifications ............................................................ 132
Comparators
C2OUT as T1 Gate ..................................................... 45
Effects of a Reset........................................................ 56
Specifications ............................................................ 132
Compare Module. See Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP)
CONFIG Register................................................................ 84
Configuration Bits................................................................ 83
CPU Features ..................................................................... 83
Customer Change Notification Service ............................. 171
Customer Notification Service........................................... 171
Customer Support ............................................................. 171
D
Data EEPROM Memory
Associated Registers .................................................. 74
Code Protection .................................................... 71, 74
Data Memory Organization ................................................... 7
Map of the PIC12F683 .................................................. 8
DC and AC Characteristics
Graphs and Tables ................................................... 137
DC Characteristics
Extended and Industrial ............................................ 121
Industrial and Extended ............................................ 117
Development Support ....................................................... 111
Device Overview ................................................................... 5
E
EEADR Register ................................................................. 71
EECON1 Register ............................................................... 72
EECON2 Register ............................................................... 72
EEDAT Register.................................................................. 71
EEPROM Data Memory
Avoiding Spurious Write.............................................. 74
Reading....................................................................... 73
Write Verify ................................................................. 73
Writing ......................................................................... 73
Effects of Reset
PWM mode ................................................................. 80
Electrical Specifications .................................................... 115
Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (ECCP)
Specifications ............................................................ 131
Errata .................................................................................... 3
DS41211D-page 168
F
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor ...................................................... 29
Fail-Safe Condition Clearing....................................... 29
Fail-Safe Detection ..................................................... 29
Fail-Safe Operation..................................................... 29
Reset or Wake-up from Sleep .................................... 29
Firmware Instructions ....................................................... 101
Fuses. See Configuration Bits
G
General Purpose Register File ............................................. 8
GPIO................................................................................... 31
Additional Pin Functions ............................................. 32
ANSEL Register ................................................. 32
Interrupt-on-Change ........................................... 32
Ultra Low-Power Wake-up............................ 32, 35
Weak Pull-up ...................................................... 32
Associated Registers .................................................. 39
GP0 ............................................................................ 36
GP1 ............................................................................ 37
GP2 ............................................................................ 37
GP3 ............................................................................ 38
GP4 ............................................................................ 38
GP5 ............................................................................ 39
Pin Descriptions and Diagrams .................................. 36
Specifications ........................................................... 127
GPIO Register .................................................................... 31
I
ID Locations........................................................................ 99
In-Circuit Debugger........................................................... 100
In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP)............................... 100
Indirect Addressing, INDF and FSR Registers ................... 18
Instruction Format............................................................. 101
Instruction Set................................................................... 101
ADDLW..................................................................... 103
ADDWF..................................................................... 103
ANDLW..................................................................... 103
ANDWF..................................................................... 103
BCF .......................................................................... 103
BSF........................................................................... 103
BTFSC ...................................................................... 103
BTFSS ...................................................................... 104
CALL......................................................................... 104
CLRF ........................................................................ 104
CLRW ....................................................................... 104
CLRWDT .................................................................. 104
COMF ....................................................................... 104
DECF ........................................................................ 104
DECFSZ ................................................................... 105
GOTO ....................................................................... 105
INCF ......................................................................... 105
INCFSZ..................................................................... 105
IORLW ...................................................................... 105
IORWF...................................................................... 105
MOVF ....................................................................... 106
MOVLW .................................................................... 106
MOVWF .................................................................... 106
NOP .......................................................................... 106
RETFIE ..................................................................... 107
RETLW ..................................................................... 107
RETURN................................................................... 107
RLF ........................................................................... 108
RRF .......................................................................... 108
SLEEP ...................................................................... 108
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
SUBLW ..................................................................... 108
SUBWF ..................................................................... 109
SWAPF ..................................................................... 109
XORLW..................................................................... 109
XORWF..................................................................... 109
INTCON Register ................................................................ 14
Internal Oscillator Block
INTOSC
Specifications............................................ 126, 127
Internal Sampling Switch (RSS) IMPEDANCE ........................ 67
Internet Address................................................................ 171
Interrupts ............................................................................. 92
ADC ............................................................................ 64
Associated Registers .................................................. 94
Comparator ................................................................. 55
Context Saving............................................................ 95
Data EEPROM Memory Write .................................... 72
GP2/INT ...................................................................... 92
GPIO Interrupt-on-change .......................................... 93
Interrupt-on-Change.................................................... 32
Timer0......................................................................... 93
TMR1 .......................................................................... 46
INTOSC Specifications ............................................. 126, 127
IOC Register ....................................................................... 34
L
Load Conditions ................................................................ 124
M
MCLR .................................................................................. 86
Internal ........................................................................ 86
Memory Organization
Data EEPROM Memory.............................................. 71
Microchip Internet Web Site .............................................. 171
Migrating from other PIC Devices ..................................... 165
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker, Librarian ................... 112
MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger ................................... 113
MPLAB ICE 2000 High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator .................................................... 113
MPLAB ICE 4000 High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator .................................................... 113
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment Software .. 111
MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer .................................... 113
MPLINK Object Linker/MPLIB Object Librarian ................ 112
O
OPCODE Field Descriptions ............................................. 101
OPTION Register .......................................................... 13, 43
OSCCON Register .............................................................. 20
Oscillator
Associated registers.............................................. 30, 48
Oscillator Module ................................................................ 19
EC ............................................................................... 19
HFINTOSC.................................................................. 19
HS ............................................................................... 19
INTOSC ...................................................................... 19
INTOSCIO................................................................... 19
LFINTOSC .................................................................. 19
LP................................................................................ 19
RC............................................................................... 19
RCIO ........................................................................... 19
XT ............................................................................... 19
Oscillator Parameters ....................................................... 126
Oscillator Specifications .................................................... 125
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
Specifications............................................................ 129
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Oscillator Switching
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor .............................................. 29
Two-Speed Clock Start-up ......................................... 27
OSCTUNE Register............................................................ 24
P
Packaging ......................................................................... 159
Details....................................................................... 160
Marking..................................................................... 159
PCL and PCLATH............................................................... 18
Computed GOTO ....................................................... 18
Stack........................................................................... 18
PCON Register ............................................................. 17, 88
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer..................... 114
PIE1 Register ..................................................................... 15
Pin Diagram .......................................................................... 2
Pinout Descriptions
PIC12F683 ................................................................... 6
PIR1 Register ..................................................................... 16
Power-Down Mode (Sleep)................................................. 98
Power-On Reset (POR) ...................................................... 86
Power-up Timer (PWRT) .................................................... 86
Specifications ........................................................... 129
Precision Internal Oscillator Parameters .......................... 127
Prescaler
Shared WDT/Timer0................................................... 42
Switching Prescaler Assignment ................................ 42
Program Memory Organization............................................. 7
Map and Stack for the PIC12F683 ............................... 7
Programming, Device Instructions.................................... 101
R
Reader Response............................................................. 172
Read-Modify-Write Operations ......................................... 101
Registers
ADCON0 (ADC Control 0) .......................................... 65
ADRESH (ADC Result High) with ADFM = 0) ............ 66
ADRESH (ADC Result High) with ADFM = 1) ............ 66
ADRESL (ADC Result Low) with ADFM = 0).............. 66
ADRESL (ADC Result Low) with ADFM = 1).............. 66
ANSEL (Analog Select) .............................................. 33
CCP1CON (CCP1 Control) ........................................ 75
CMCON0 (Comparator Control) Register................... 56
CMCON1 (Comparator Control) Register................... 57
CONFIG (Configuration Word) ................................... 84
EEADR (EEPROM Address) ...................................... 71
EECON1 (EEPROM Control 1) .................................. 72
EECON2 (EEPROM Control 2) .................................. 72
EEDAT (EEPROM Data) ............................................ 71
GPIO........................................................................... 31
INTCON (Interrupt Control) ........................................ 14
IOC (Interrupt-on-Change GPIO) ............................... 34
OPTION_REG (OPTION)..................................... 13, 43
OSCCON (Oscillator Control)..................................... 20
OSCTUNE (Oscillator Tuning).................................... 24
PCON (Power Control Register)................................. 17
PCON (Power Control) ............................................... 88
PIE1 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 1) .......................... 15
PIR1 (Peripheral Interrupt Register 1) ........................ 16
Reset Values .............................................................. 90
Reset Values (Special Registers)............................... 91
STATUS ..................................................................... 12
T1CON ....................................................................... 47
T2CON ....................................................................... 50
TRISIO (Tri-State GPIO) ............................................ 32
VRCON (Voltage Reference Control) ......................... 58
DS41211D-page 169
PIC12F683
WDTCON (Watchdog Timer Control).......................... 97
WPU (Weak Pull-Up GPIO) ........................................ 34
Resets ................................................................................. 85
Brown-out Reset (BOR) .............................................. 85
MCLR Reset, Normal Operation ................................. 85
MCLR Reset, Sleep .................................................... 85
Power-on Reset (POR) ............................................... 85
WDT Reset, Normal Operation ................................... 85
WDT Reset, Sleep ...................................................... 85
Revision History ................................................................ 165
S
Sleep
Power-Down Mode ..................................................... 98
Wake-up...................................................................... 98
Wake-up Using Interrupts ........................................... 98
Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM)..................................... 112
Special Event Trigger.......................................................... 64
Special Function Registers ................................................... 8
STATUS Register................................................................ 12
T
T1CON Register.................................................................. 47
T2CON Register.................................................................. 50
Thermal Considerations .................................................... 123
Time-out Sequence............................................................. 88
Timer0 ................................................................................. 41
Associated Registers .................................................. 43
External Clock ............................................................. 42
Interrupt................................................................. 13, 43
Operation .............................................................. 41, 44
Specifications ............................................................ 130
T0CKI .......................................................................... 42
Timer1 ................................................................................. 44
Associated registers.................................................... 48
Asynchronous Counter Mode ..................................... 45
Reading and Writing ........................................... 45
Interrupt....................................................................... 46
Modes of Operation .................................................... 44
Operation During Sleep .............................................. 46
Oscillator ..................................................................... 45
Prescaler ..................................................................... 45
Specifications ............................................................ 130
Timer1 Gate
Inverting Gate ..................................................... 45
Selecting Source........................................... 45, 57
Synchronizing COUT w/Timer1 .......................... 57
TMR1H Register ......................................................... 44
TMR1L Register .......................................................... 44
Timer2
Associated registers.................................................... 50
Timers
Timer1
T1CON................................................................ 47
Timer2
T2CON................................................................ 50
Timing Diagrams
A/D Conversion ......................................................... 135
A/D Conversion (Sleep Mode) .................................. 135
Brown-out Reset (BOR) ............................................ 128
Brown-out Reset Situations ........................................ 87
CLKOUT and I/O....................................................... 127
Clock Timing ............................................................. 125
Comparator Output ..................................................... 51
Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM (ECCP) ............. 131
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) ................................. 30
DS41211D-page 170
INT Pin Interrupt ......................................................... 94
Internal Oscillator Switch Timing ................................ 26
Reset, WDT, OST and Power-up Timer ................... 128
Time-out Sequence on Power-up (Delayed MCLR) ... 89
Time-out Sequence on Power-up (MCLR with VDD) .. 89
Timer0 and Timer1 External Clock ........................... 130
Timer1 Incrementing Edge ......................................... 46
Two Speed Start-up.................................................... 28
Wake-up from Sleep Through Interrupt ...................... 99
Timing Parameter Symbology .......................................... 124
TRISIO Register ................................................................. 32
Two-Speed Clock Start-up Mode........................................ 27
U
Ultra Low-Power Wake-up............................................ 32, 35
V
Voltage Reference. See Comparator Voltage
Reference (CVREF)
Voltage References
Associated registers ................................................... 59
VREF. SEE ADC Reference Voltage
W
Wake-up Using Interrupts ................................................... 98
Watchdog Timer (WDT)...................................................... 96
Associated Registers .................................................. 97
Clock Source .............................................................. 96
Modes ......................................................................... 96
Period ......................................................................... 96
Specifications ........................................................... 129
WDTCON Register ............................................................. 97
WPU Register ..................................................................... 34
WWW Address ................................................................. 171
WWW, On-Line Support ....................................................... 3
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
THE MICROCHIP WEB SITE
CUSTOMER SUPPORT
Microchip provides online support via our WWW site at
www.microchip.com. This web site is used as a means
to make files and information easily available to
customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet
browser, the web site contains the following information:
Users of Microchip products can receive assistance
through several channels:
• Product Support – Data sheets and errata, application notes and sample programs, design
resources, user’s guides and hardware support
documents, latest software releases and archived
software
• General Technical Support – Frequently Asked
Questions (FAQ), technical support requests,
online discussion groups, Microchip consultant
program member listing
• Business of Microchip – Product selector and
ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases,
listing of seminars and events, listings of Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory representatives
•
•
•
•
•
Distributor or Representative
Local Sales Office
Field Application Engineer (FAE)
Technical Support
Development Systems Information Line
Customers should contact their distributor, representative or field application engineer (FAE) for support.
Local sales offices are also available to help customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is included in
the back of this document.
Technical support is available through the web site
at: http://support.microchip.com
CUSTOMER CHANGE NOTIFICATION
SERVICE
Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep
customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers
will receive e-mail notification whenever there are
changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a specified product family or development tool of interest.
To register, access the Microchip web site at
www.microchip.com, click on Customer Change Notification and follow the registration instructions.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS41211D-page 171
PIC12F683
READER RESPONSE
It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip product. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter, and ways in which our documentation
can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (480) 792-4150.
Please list the following information, and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this document.
To:
Technical Publications Manager
RE:
Reader Response
Total Pages Sent ________
From: Name
Company
Address
City / State / ZIP / Country
Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________
FAX: (______) _________ - _________
Application (optional):
Would you like a reply?
Device: PIC12F683
Y
N
Literature Number: DS41211D
Questions:
1. What are the best features of this document?
2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs?
3. Do you find the organization of this document easy to follow? If not, why?
4. What additions to the document do you think would enhance the structure and subject?
5. What deletions from the document could be made without affecting the overall usefulness?
6. Is there any incorrect or misleading information (what and where)?
7. How would you improve this document?
DS41211D-page 172
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC12F683
PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM
To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales office.
PART NO.
X
/XX
XXX
Device
Temperature
Range
Package
Pattern
Examples:
a)
b)
Device:
PIC12F683(1), PIC12F683T(2)
VDD range 2.0V to 5.5V
Temperature
Range:
I
E
= -40°C to +85°C(Industrial)
= -40°C to +125°C (Extended)
Package:
P
MD
MF
SN
=
=
=
=
Pattern:
3-digit Pattern Code for QTP (blank otherwise)
PIC12F683-E/P 301 = Extended Temp., PDIP
package, 20 MHz, QTP pattern #301
PIC12F683-I/SN = Industrial Temp., SOIC
package, 20 MHz
Plastic DIP
Dual-Flat, No Leads (DFN-S, 4x4x0.9 mm)
Dual-Flat, No Leads (DFN-S, 6x5 mm)
8-lead Small Outline (3.90 mm)
Note 1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
2:
F = Standard Voltage Range
LF = Wide Voltage Range
T = in tape and reel PLCC, and TQFP
packages only.
DS41211D-page 173
WORLDWIDE SALES AND SERVICE
AMERICAS
ASIA/PACIFIC
ASIA/PACIFIC
EUROPE
Corporate Office
2355 West Chandler Blvd.
Chandler, AZ 85224-6199
Tel: 480-792-7200
Fax: 480-792-7277
Technical Support:
http://support.microchip.com
Web Address:
www.microchip.com
Asia Pacific Office
Suites 3707-14, 37th Floor
Tower 6, The Gateway
Habour City, Kowloon
Hong Kong
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
India - Bangalore
Tel: 91-80-4182-8400
Fax: 91-80-4182-8422
India - New Delhi
Tel: 91-11-4160-8631
Fax: 91-11-4160-8632
Austria - Wels
Tel: 43-7242-2244-39
Fax: 43-7242-2244-393
Denmark - Copenhagen
Tel: 45-4450-2828
Fax: 45-4485-2829
India - Pune
Tel: 91-20-2566-1512
Fax: 91-20-2566-1513
France - Paris
Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20
Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79
Japan - Yokohama
Tel: 81-45-471- 6166
Fax: 81-45-471-6122
Germany - Munich
Tel: 49-89-627-144-0
Fax: 49-89-627-144-44
Atlanta
Duluth, GA
Tel: 678-957-9614
Fax: 678-957-1455
Boston
Westborough, MA
Tel: 774-760-0087
Fax: 774-760-0088
Chicago
Itasca, IL
Tel: 630-285-0071
Fax: 630-285-0075
Dallas
Addison, TX
Tel: 972-818-7423
Fax: 972-818-2924
Detroit
Farmington Hills, MI
Tel: 248-538-2250
Fax: 248-538-2260
Kokomo
Kokomo, IN
Tel: 765-864-8360
Fax: 765-864-8387
Los Angeles
Mission Viejo, CA
Tel: 949-462-9523
Fax: 949-462-9608
Santa Clara
Santa Clara, CA
Tel: 408-961-6444
Fax: 408-961-6445
Toronto
Mississauga, Ontario,
Canada
Tel: 905-673-0699
Fax: 905-673-6509
Australia - Sydney
Tel: 61-2-9868-6733
Fax: 61-2-9868-6755
China - Beijing
Tel: 86-10-8528-2100
Fax: 86-10-8528-2104
China - Chengdu
Tel: 86-28-8665-5511
Fax: 86-28-8665-7889
Korea - Gumi
Tel: 82-54-473-4301
Fax: 82-54-473-4302
China - Fuzhou
Tel: 86-591-8750-3506
Fax: 86-591-8750-3521
Korea - Seoul
Tel: 82-2-554-7200
Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or
82-2-558-5934
China - Hong Kong SAR
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
Malaysia - Penang
Tel: 60-4-646-8870
Fax: 60-4-646-5086
China - Qingdao
Tel: 86-532-8502-7355
Fax: 86-532-8502-7205
Philippines - Manila
Tel: 63-2-634-9065
Fax: 63-2-634-9069
China - Shanghai
Tel: 86-21-5407-5533
Fax: 86-21-5407-5066
Singapore
Tel: 65-6334-8870
Fax: 65-6334-8850
China - Shenyang
Tel: 86-24-2334-2829
Fax: 86-24-2334-2393
Taiwan - Hsin Chu
Tel: 886-3-572-9526
Fax: 886-3-572-6459
China - Shenzhen
Tel: 86-755-8203-2660
Fax: 86-755-8203-1760
Taiwan - Kaohsiung
Tel: 886-7-536-4818
Fax: 886-7-536-4803
China - Shunde
Tel: 86-757-2839-5507
Fax: 86-757-2839-5571
Taiwan - Taipei
Tel: 886-2-2500-6610
Fax: 886-2-2508-0102
China - Wuhan
Tel: 86-27-5980-5300
Fax: 86-27-5980-5118
Thailand - Bangkok
Tel: 66-2-694-1351
Fax: 66-2-694-1350
Italy - Milan
Tel: 39-0331-742611
Fax: 39-0331-466781
Netherlands - Drunen
Tel: 31-416-690399
Fax: 31-416-690340
Spain - Madrid
Tel: 34-91-708-08-90
Fax: 34-91-708-08-91
UK - Wokingham
Tel: 44-118-921-5869
Fax: 44-118-921-5820
China - Xian
Tel: 86-29-8833-7250
Fax: 86-29-8833-7256
12/08/06
DS41211D-page 174
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.